blob: 2f1e57e44914ed6b850a4fabe83e7a8740dd7327 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6e893b92019-03-26 05:40:51 +01007 2019/03/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100599
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200601 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200603 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100604 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100605 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100606 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200607 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200608 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200609 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - noepoll
612 - nokqueue
613 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100614 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300615 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000616 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100617 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200618 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200619 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200620 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000621 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000622 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - tune.buffers.limit
624 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200625 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200626 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100627 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200628 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200629 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200630 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100631 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200632 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200633 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100634 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100635 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100636 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100637 - tune.lua.session-timeout
638 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200639 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100640 - tune.maxaccept
641 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200642 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200643 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200644 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100645 - tune.rcvbuf.client
646 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100647 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200648 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100649 - tune.sndbuf.client
650 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100651 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100652 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200653 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100654 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200655 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200656 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100657 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200658 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100659 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200660 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
661 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
662 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100663 - tune.zlib.memlevel
664 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100665
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200666 * Debugging
667 - debug
668 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200669
670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006713.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672------------------------------------
673
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200674ca-base <dir>
675 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200676 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
677 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200679chroot <jail dir>
680 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
681 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
682 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
683 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
684 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100685 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100686
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100687cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
688 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
689 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
690 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
691 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
692 set. These sets have the format
693
694 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
695
696 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100697 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100698 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
699 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100700 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
701 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100702 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100703 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100705 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100706 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
707 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
708 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
709 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100710
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100711 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
712 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
713 on the machine's word size.
714
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100715 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100716 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
717 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
718 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
719 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
720 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
721 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100722
723 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
725
726 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
727 # first 4 CPUs
728
729 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
730 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
731 # word size.
732
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100733 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100734 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100735 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
736 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
737 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
738
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
740 # and so on.
741 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100745 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100746 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
747 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
748 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
749
750 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
751 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
752 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
753
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
755 # and a thread range.
756 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
757 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
759
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200760crt-base <dir>
761 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
762 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
763 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
764
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765daemon
766 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
767 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100768 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
769 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200771deviceatlas-json-file <path>
772 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100773 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200774
775deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100776 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
778
779deviceatlas-separator <char>
780 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
781 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
782
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100783deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200784 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
785 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
786 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100787
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900788external-check
789 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
790 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
791 See "option external-check".
792
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200793gid <number>
794 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
795 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
796 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100797 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
798 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100800
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100801hard-stop-after <time>
802 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
803
804 Arguments :
805 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
806 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
807 SIGUSR1 signal.
808
809 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
810 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
811 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
812
813 Example:
814 global
815 hard-stop-after 30s
816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817group <group name>
818 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
819 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100820
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200821log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100822 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100823 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100824 configured with "log global".
825
826 <address> can be one of:
827
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100828 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100829 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
830 port).
831
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100832 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
833 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
834 port).
835
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100836 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100837 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
838 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100839 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100840
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100841 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
842 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
843 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
844 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
845 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
846 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
847 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
848 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
849 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
850 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
851 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
852 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
853 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
854 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100855 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
856 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100857
858 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
859 "fd@2", see above.
860
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200861 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
862 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100863
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200864 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
865 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
866 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
867 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
868 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
869 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
870 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
871 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
872 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
873 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100874 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
875 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200876
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200877 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
878 one of the following :
879
880 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
881 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
882
883 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
884 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
885
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100886 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
887 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
888 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
889 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
890 logger consumes.
891
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100892 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
893 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
894 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
895 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
896
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100897 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200898
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100899 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
900 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
901 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
902
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100903 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
904 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
905 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
906 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200907
908 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200909 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
910 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
911 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
912 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
913 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
914 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200916 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200917
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100918log-send-hostname [<string>]
919 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
920 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
921 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
922 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
923 the logs.
924
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000925log-tag <string>
926 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
927 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
928 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100929 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000930
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100931lua-load <file>
932 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
933 used multiple times.
934
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100935master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200936 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
937 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
938 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100939 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200940 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
941 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100942 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
943 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
944 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
945 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
946 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200947
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200949
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200950nbproc <number>
951 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
952 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
953 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100954 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
955 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100956 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
957 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200959nbthread <number>
960 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100961 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
962 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
963 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
964 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
965 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100966 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
967 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
968 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
969 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
970 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
971 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
972 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200973
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100975 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
977 starting the process. See also "daemon".
978
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100979presetenv <name> <value>
980 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
981 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
982 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
983 and "unsetenv".
984
985resetenv [<name> ...]
986 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
987 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
988 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
989 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
990 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
991 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
992 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
993 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
994
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100995stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200996 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
997 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
998 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
999 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1000 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1001 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001002 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001003 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1004 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1005 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1006 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001007
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001008server-state-base <directory>
1009 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001010 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1011 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001012
1013server-state-file <file>
1014 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1015 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1016 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1017 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1018 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1019 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1020 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1021 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001022 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1023 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001024
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001025setenv <name> <value>
1026 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1027 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1028 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1029 and "unsetenv".
1030
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001031ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1033 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001034 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001035 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001036 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1037 information and recommendations see e.g.
1038 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1039 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1040 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1041 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001042
1043ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1044 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1045 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1046 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1047 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1048 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001049 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1050 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1051 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001052 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001053
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001054ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1055 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1056 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1057 keyword to see available options.
1058
1059 Example:
1060 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001061 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001062
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001063ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1065 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001066 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001067 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001068 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1069 information and recommendations see e.g.
1070 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1071 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1072 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1073 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1074 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001075
1076ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1078 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1079 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1080 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1081 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001082 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1083 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1084 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1085 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001086
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001087ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1088 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1089 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1090 keyword to see available options.
1091
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001092ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1094 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1095 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001096 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001097 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001098 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1099 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1100 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1101 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001102 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1103 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1104 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1105
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001106ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1107 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1108 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1109 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1110
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001111stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1112 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1113 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1114 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001115 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001116 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001117
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001118 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1119 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1120 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001121
1122stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1123 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1124 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001125 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001126
1127stats maxconn <connections>
1128 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1129 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131uid <number>
1132 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1133 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1134 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1135 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1136
1137ulimit-n <number>
1138 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1139 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1140 option.
1141
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001142unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1143 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1144
1145 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1146 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1147 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1148 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1149 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1150 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1151 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1152 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1153 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1154 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1155
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001156unsetenv [<name> ...]
1157 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1158 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1159 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1160 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1161 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1162 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1163 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1164
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001165user <user name>
1166 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1167 See also "uid" and "group".
1168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001169node <name>
1170 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1171
1172 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1173 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1174 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1175 traffic.
1176
1177description <text>
1178 Add a text that describes the instance.
1179
1180 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1181 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1182 "<" and ">" characters.
1183
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100118451degrees-data-file <file path>
1185 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001186 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001187
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001188 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001189 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1190
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000119151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001192 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1193 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1194 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1195
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001196 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001197 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1198
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200119951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001200 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1201 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1202
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001203 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1204 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1205
120651degrees-cache-size <number>
1207 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1208 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1209 By default, this cache is disabled.
1210
1211 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001212 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1213
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012153.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001216-----------------------
1217
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001218busy-polling
1219 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1220 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1221 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1222 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1223 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1224 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1225 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1226 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1227 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1228 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1229 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1230 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1231 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1232 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1233 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1234 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1235 "poll" pollers.
1236
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001237max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1238 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1239 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1240 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1241 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1242 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1243 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1244 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1245 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1246
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247maxconn <number>
1248 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1249 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1250 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001251 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1252 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1253 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1254 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001255 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1256 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1257 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1258 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1259 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1260 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001261
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001262maxconnrate <number>
1263 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1264 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1265 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1266 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1267 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1268 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1269 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1270 fairness.
1271
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001272maxcomprate <number>
1273 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001274 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001275 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1276 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1277 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001278 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001279 default value.
1280
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001281maxcompcpuusage <number>
1282 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1283 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1284 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1285 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1286 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1287 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1288 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1289 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1290
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001291maxpipes <number>
1292 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1293 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1294 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1295 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1296 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1297 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1298
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001299maxsessrate <number>
1300 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1301 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1302 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1303 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1304 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1305 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1306 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1307 fairness.
1308
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001309maxsslconn <number>
1310 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1311 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1312 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1313 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1314 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1315 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1316 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001317 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1318 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1319 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1320 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1321 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1322 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1323 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001324
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001325maxsslrate <number>
1326 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1327 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1328 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1329 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1330 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1331 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1332 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1333 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1334 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1335 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1336
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001337maxzlibmem <number>
1338 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1339 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1340 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001341 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1342 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1343 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1344
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001345noepoll
1346 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1347 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001348 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001349
1350nokqueue
1351 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1352 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1353 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1354
1355nopoll
1356 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1357 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001358 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001359 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001360
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001361nosplice
1362 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001363 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001364 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001365 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001366 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1367 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1368 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1369 "option splice-response".
1370
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001371nogetaddrinfo
1372 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1373 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1374
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001375noreuseport
1376 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1377 command line argument "-dR".
1378
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001379profiling.tasks { on | off }
1380 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1381 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1382 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1383 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1384 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1385 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1386 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1387 CLI.
1388
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001389spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001390 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1391 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1392 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1393 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1394 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1395 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001396
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001397ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001398 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001399 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001400 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1401 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1402 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1403 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1404 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001405 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1406 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001407 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1408 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1409 openssl configuration file uses:
1410 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1411
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001412ssl-mode-async
1413 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001414 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001415 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1416 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1417 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1418 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1419 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001420
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001421tune.buffers.limit <number>
1422 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1423 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1424 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1425 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1426 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001427 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001428 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1429 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1430 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1431 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1432 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1433 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1434 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1435 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1436 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1437
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001438tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1439 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1440 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1441 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1442 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1443
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001444tune.bufsize <number>
1445 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1446 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1447 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1448 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1449 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1450 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1451 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001452 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1453 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1454 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001455 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001456 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1457 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1458 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001459
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001460tune.chksize <number>
1461 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1462 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1463 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1464 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1465 checks whenever possible.
1466
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001467tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1468 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1469 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1470 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1471 this value. The default value is 1.
1472
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001473tune.fail-alloc
1474 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1475 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1476 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1477 gracefully.
1478
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001479tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1480 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1481 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1482 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1483 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1484 change it.
1485
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001486tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1487 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001488 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1489 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001490 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1491 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1492 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1493 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1494 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1495
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001496tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1497 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1498 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1499 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1500 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1501 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1502 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1503 recommended not to change this value.
1504
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001505tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1506 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1507 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1508 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1509 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1510 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1511 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1512 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1513
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001514tune.http.cookielen <number>
1515 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1516 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1517 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1518 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1519 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1520 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1521 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1522 to change this value.
1523
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001524tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1526 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001527 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001528 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001529 configuration directives too.
1530 The default value is 1024.
1531
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001532tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1533 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1534 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1535 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1536 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1537 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1538 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001539 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1540 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1541 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001542
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001543tune.idletimer <timeout>
1544 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1545 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1546 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1547 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1548 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1549 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001550 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001551 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1552 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1553
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001554tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1555 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1556 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1557 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1558 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1559 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1560 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1561 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1562 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1563 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1564
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001565tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1566 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001567 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001568 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1569 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001570 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001571 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1572 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1573
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001574tune.lua.maxmem
1575 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1576 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1577 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1578 memory.
1579
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001580tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1581 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001582 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1583 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001584 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001585
1586tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1587 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1588 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1589 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1590 check servers.
1591
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001592tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1593 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1594 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1595 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001596 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001597
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001598tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001599 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1600 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1601 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1602 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1603 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1604 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1605 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1606 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1607 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1608 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001609
1610tune.maxpollevents <number>
1611 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1612 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1613 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1614 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1615 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1616
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001617tune.maxrewrite <number>
1618 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1619 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1620 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1621 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1622 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1623 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1624 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1625 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1626 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1627 bufsize.
1628
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001629tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1630 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1631 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1632 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1633 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1634 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1635 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1636 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1637 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1638 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1639 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1640 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1641 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1642 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1643 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1644 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1645 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1646 setting this parameter to 0.
1647
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001648tune.pipesize <number>
1649 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1650 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1651 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1652 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1653 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1654 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1655
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001656tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1657tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1658 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1659 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1660 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1661 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001662 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001663 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1664 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1665
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001666tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001667 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001668 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1669 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1670 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1671 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1672
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001673tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1674 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1675 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1676 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1677
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001678tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1679tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1680 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1681 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1682 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1683 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001684 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001685 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1686 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1687 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1688 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1689 notifying haproxy again.
1690
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001691tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001692 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1693 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1694 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001695 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001696 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001697 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001698 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1699 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1700 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001701 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1702 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001703
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001704tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001705 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001706 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1707 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1708 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1709 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1710 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1711
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001712tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1713 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001714 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001715 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1716 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1717 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1718 being used for too long.
1719
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001720tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1721 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1722 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1723 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1724 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1725 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1726 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1727 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1728 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1729 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1730 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001731 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001732 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001733
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001734tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1735 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1736 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1737 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1738 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1739 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1740 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1741 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001742 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1743 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001744
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001745tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1746 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1747 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1748 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1749 1000 entries.
1750
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001751tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1752 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1753 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1754 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1755
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001756tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001757tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001758tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1759tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1760tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001761 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1762 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1763 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1764 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1765 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1766 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1767 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1768 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001769
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001770 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1771 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1772 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1773 all available space is consumed.
1774 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1775 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1776 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001777
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001778tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1779 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001780 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001781 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001782 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001783 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1784
1785tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1786 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1787 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001788 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1789 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017913.3. Debugging
1792--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001793
1794debug
1795 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1796 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1797 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1798 system startup.
1799
1800quiet
1801 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1802 line argument "-q".
1803
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018053.4. Userlists
1806--------------
1807It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1808http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1809it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1810
1811userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001812 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001813 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1814
1815group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001816 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001817 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1818 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1819
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001820user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1821 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001822 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1823 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001824 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1825 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1826 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1827 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001828
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001829 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1830 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1831 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1832 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1833 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1834 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1835 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1836 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1837 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001838
1839 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001840 userlist L1
1841 group G1 users tiger,scott
1842 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001843
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001844 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1845 user scott insecure-password elgato
1846 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001847
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001848 userlist L2
1849 group G1
1850 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001851
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001852 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1853 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1854 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001855
1856 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001857
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001858
18593.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001860----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001861It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1862several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1863instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1864values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1865automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1866In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1867using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1868tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1869reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1870Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1871that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1872each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001873
1874peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001875 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001876 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1877
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001878bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1879 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1880 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1881
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001882disabled
1883 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1884 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1885 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1886
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001887default-bind [param*]
1888 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1889
1890default-server [param*]
1891 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1892
1893 Arguments:
1894 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1895 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1896 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1897 details.
1898
1899
1900 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1901
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001902enable
1903 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1904
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001905peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001906 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1907 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1908 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1909 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1910 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1911 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1912
1913 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1914 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1915
1916 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1917 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1918 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1919 across all peers.
1920
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001921 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1922 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001923
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001924 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
1925 "server" keyword explanation below).
1926
1927server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
1928 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
1929 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
1930 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
1931 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
1932 of this "peers" section).
1933 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
1934
1935
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001936 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001937 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001938 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001939 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1940 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1941 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001942
1943 backend mybackend
1944 mode tcp
1945 balance roundrobin
1946 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1947 stick on src
1948
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001949 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1950 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001951
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001952 Example:
1953 peers mypeers
1954 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
1955 default-server ssl verify none
1956 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
1957 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001958
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019593.6. Mailers
1960------------
1961It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1962If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1963in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1964
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001965mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001966 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1967 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1968
1969mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1970 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1971
1972 Example:
1973 mailers mymailers
1974 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1975 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1976
1977 backend mybackend
1978 mode tcp
1979 balance roundrobin
1980
1981 email-alert mailers mymailers
1982 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1983 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1984
1985 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1986 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1987
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001988timeout mail <time>
1989 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1990 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1991 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1992 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1993
1994 Example:
1995 mailers mymailers
1996 timeout mail 20s
1997 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019994. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002000----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002002Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002003 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002004 - frontend <name>
2005 - backend <name>
2006 - listen <name>
2007
2008A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2009its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2010section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002012
2013A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2014connections.
2015
2016A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2017to forward incoming connections.
2018
2019A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2020parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002022All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2023'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2024case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2025
2026Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2027logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2028proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2029However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2030name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2031
2032Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2033and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002034bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2036modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2037arbitrary criteria.
2038
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002039In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2040a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002041the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002042
2043 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2044 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2045 between responses and new requests.
2046
2047 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2048 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2049 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002050 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2051 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2052 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2053 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002054
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002055 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2056 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2057 client-facing connection remains open.
2058
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002059 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2060 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002061
2062The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2063frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2064following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002065weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002066
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002067 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002068
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002069 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2070 ----+-----+-----+----
2071 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2072 ----+-----+-----+----
2073 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2074 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2075 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2076 ----+-----+-----+----
2077 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002079
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020814.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2082--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002084The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2085limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2086they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2087limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002088marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002089option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002090and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2091with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2092specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002094
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002095 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2096------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2097acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002098appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002099backlog X X X -
2100balance X - X X
2101bind - X X -
2102bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002103block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002104capture cookie - X X -
2105capture request header - X X -
2106capture response header - X X -
2107clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002108compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002109contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2110cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002111declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002112default-server X - X X
2113default_backend X X X -
2114description - X X X
2115disabled X X X X
2116dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002117email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002118email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002119email-alert mailers X X X X
2120email-alert myhostname X X X X
2121email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002122enabled X X X X
2123errorfile X X X X
2124errorloc X X X X
2125errorloc302 X X X X
2126-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2127errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002128force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002129filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002130fullconn X - X X
2131grace X X X X
2132hash-type X - X X
2133http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002134http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002135http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002136http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002137http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002138http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002139http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002140id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002141ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002142load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002143log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002144log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002145log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002146log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002147max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002148maxconn X X X -
2149mode X X X X
2150monitor fail - X X -
2151monitor-net X X X -
2152monitor-uri X X X -
2153option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2154option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2155option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2156option allbackups (*) X - X X
2157option checkcache (*) X - X X
2158option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2159option contstats (*) X X X -
2160option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2161option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002162option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002163-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2164option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002165option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002166option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002167option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002168option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002169option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002170option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002171option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002172option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002173option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002174option httpchk X - X X
2175option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002176option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002177option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002178option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002179option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002180option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002181option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2182option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2183option logasap (*) X X X -
2184option mysql-check X - X X
2185option nolinger (*) X X X X
2186option originalto X X X X
2187option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002188option pgsql-check X - X X
2189option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002190option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002191option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002192option smtpchk X - X X
2193option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2194option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2195option splice-request (*) X X X X
2196option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002197option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002198option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2199option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2200-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002201option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002202option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2203option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2204option tcpka X X X X
2205option tcplog X X X X
2206option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002207external-check command X - X X
2208external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002209persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2210rate-limit sessions X X X -
2211redirect - X X X
2212redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2213redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2214reqadd - X X X
2215reqallow - X X X
2216reqdel - X X X
2217reqdeny - X X X
2218reqiallow - X X X
2219reqidel - X X X
2220reqideny - X X X
2221reqipass - X X X
2222reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002223reqitarpit - X X X
2224reqpass - X X X
2225reqrep - X X X
2226-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002227reqtarpit - X X X
2228retries X - X X
2229rspadd - X X X
2230rspdel - X X X
2231rspdeny - X X X
2232rspidel - X X X
2233rspideny - X X X
2234rspirep - X X X
2235rsprep - X X X
2236server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002237server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002238server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002239source X - X X
2240srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002241stats admin - X X X
2242stats auth X X X X
2243stats enable X X X X
2244stats hide-version X X X X
2245stats http-request - X X X
2246stats realm X X X X
2247stats refresh X X X X
2248stats scope X X X X
2249stats show-desc X X X X
2250stats show-legends X X X X
2251stats show-node X X X X
2252stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002253-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2254stick match - - X X
2255stick on - - X X
2256stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002257stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002258stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002259tcp-check connect - - X X
2260tcp-check expect - - X X
2261tcp-check send - - X X
2262tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002263tcp-request connection - X X -
2264tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002265tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002266tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002267tcp-response content - - X X
2268tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002269timeout check X - X X
2270timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002271timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002272timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2273timeout connect X - X X
2274timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2275timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2276timeout http-request X X X X
2277timeout queue X - X X
2278timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002279timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002280timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2281timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002282timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002283transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002284unique-id-format X X X -
2285unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002286use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002287use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002288------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2289 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002290
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2293---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002294
2295This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2296
2297
2298acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2299 Declare or complete an access list.
2300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2301 no | yes | yes | yes
2302 Example:
2303 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2304 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2305 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002307 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308
2309
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002310appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2311 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002312 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2314 no | no | yes | yes
2315 Arguments :
2316 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2317 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2318
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002319 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320 checked in each cookie value.
2321
2322 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2323 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2324 milliseconds.
2325
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002326 request-learn
2327 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2328 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2329 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2330 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2331 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2332 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2333
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002334 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2335 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2336 data following this prefix.
2337
2338 Example :
2339 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002341 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2342 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002343
2344 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2345 2 modes are currently supported :
2346 - path-parameters :
2347 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2348 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2349 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2350 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2351 - query-string :
2352 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2353 query string.
2354
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002355 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2356 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2357 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002358
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002359 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2360 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361
2362
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002363backlog <conns>
2364 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2366 yes | yes | yes | no
2367 Arguments :
2368 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2369 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002370 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002371
2372 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2373 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2374 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2375 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2376 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2377 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2378 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2379 backlog parameter.
2380
2381 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2382 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2383 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2384
2385 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2386
2387
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002388balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002389balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2392 yes | no | yes | yes
2393 Arguments :
2394 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2395 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2396 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2397 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2398
2399 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2400 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2401 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2402 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002403 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002404 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002405 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2406 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2407 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2408 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2409 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2410 it, so that you don't worry.
2411
2412 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2413 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2414 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2415 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2416 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2417 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2418 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2419 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002420
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002421 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2422 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2423 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2424 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2425 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2426 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2427 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2428 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2429
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002430 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002431 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002432 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2433 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002434 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002435 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2436 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2437 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2438 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2439 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002440 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2441 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2442 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2443 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2444 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2445 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2448 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2449 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2450 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2451 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2452 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2453 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2454 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002455 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002456 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002457 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2458 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2459 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002461 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2462 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2463 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2464 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2465 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2466 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2467 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2468 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2469 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2470 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2471 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2472 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002474 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002475 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2476 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2477 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2478 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2479 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2480 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2481 URIs start with a leading "/".
2482
2483 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2484 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2485 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2486 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2487
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002488 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002489 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2490
2491 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002492 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2493 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002494 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2495 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2496 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2497 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002498 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002499 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2500 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002501
2502 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2503 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2504 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2505 server will receive the request.
2506
2507 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2508 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2509 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2510 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2511 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002512 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2513 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2514 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002516 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2517 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2518 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2519 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2520 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002522 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002523 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2524 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2525 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2526
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002527 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2528 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2529 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2530
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002531 random
2532 random(<draws>)
2533 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002534 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2535 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2536 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2537 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002538 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2539 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2540 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2541 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2542 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2543 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2544 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2545 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2546 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2547 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2548 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2549 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2550 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2551 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2552 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2553 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2554 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2555 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2556 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2557 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002558
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002559 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002560 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002561 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2562 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2563 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2564 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2565 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2566 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002567 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002568 used instead.
2569
2570 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2571 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2572 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2573 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2574
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002575 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2576 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2577 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2578
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002579 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002582 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2583 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002584
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002585 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2586 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2587 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002589 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2590 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2591 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2592 NTLM relies on.
2593
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594 Examples :
2595 balance roundrobin
2596 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002597 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002598 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2599 balance hdr(host)
2600 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002601
2602 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2603 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002605 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002606 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2607 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2608 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2609 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2610
2611 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2612 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2613 defaults to 16 kB.
2614
2615 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2616 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2617
2618 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2619 Round Robin.
2620
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002621 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002622 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2623 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2624 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2625
2626 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2627
2628 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002629 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002630 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2631 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2632 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002634 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635
2636
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002637bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2638bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002639 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2641 no | yes | yes | no
2642 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002643 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2644 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2645 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2646 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002647 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002648 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2649 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2650 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2651 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2652 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2653 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2654 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002655 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2656 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2657 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2658 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2659 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2660 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2661 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002662 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2663 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2664 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002665 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2666 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2667 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2668 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002669 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2670 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2671 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002672
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002673 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2674 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002675 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2676 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2677 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002678 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2679 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2680 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2681 the range.
2682
2683 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2684 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2685 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2686 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2687 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2688 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2689 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002690 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002691 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002693 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002694 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002695 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2696 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2697 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2698 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2699 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2700 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2701
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002702 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2703 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2704 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2705 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2708 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2709 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2710 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2711 in a frontend.
2712
2713 Example :
2714 listen http_proxy
2715 bind :80,:443
2716 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002717 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002719 listen http_https_proxy
2720 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002721 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002722
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002723 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2724 bind ipv6@:80
2725 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2726 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2727
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002728 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002729 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002730
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002731 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2732 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2733 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2734 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2735 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2736
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002737 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002738 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002739
2740
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002741bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002742 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2744 yes | yes | yes | yes
2745 Arguments :
2746 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2747 may be used to override a default value.
2748
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002749 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002750 option may be combined with other numbers.
2751
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002752 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002753 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2754 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2755 missing from all processes.
2756
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002757 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002758 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002759 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2760 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2761 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2762 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2763 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002764 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002765
2766 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2767 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2768 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2769 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2770 and 'even' instances.
2771
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002772 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2773 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2774 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2775 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002776
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002777 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2778 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2779
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002780 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2781 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2782 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2783
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002784 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2785 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2786
2787 Example :
2788 listen app_ip1
2789 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002790 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002791
2792 listen app_ip2
2793 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002794 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002795
2796 listen management
2797 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002798 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002799
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002800 listen management
2801 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2802 bind-process 1-4
2803
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002804 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002805
2806
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002807block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 no | yes | yes | yes
2811
2812 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2813 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002814 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002815 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002817 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2818 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2819 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002820
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002821 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2822 "http-request deny" instead.
2823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002824 Example:
2825 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2826 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2827 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002828 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2829 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2830 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002831
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002832 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2833 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2834 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
2836capture cookie <name> len <length>
2837 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2839 no | yes | yes | no
2840 Arguments :
2841 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2842 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2843 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2844 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002845 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846
2847 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2848 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2849 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2850 right if it exceeds <length>.
2851
2852 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2853 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2854 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2855 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2856
2857 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2858 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2859 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2860
2861 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2862 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2863 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002864 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2865 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2866 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867
2868 Example:
2869 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2870
2871 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002872 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002873
2874
2875capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002876 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2878 no | yes | yes | no
2879 Arguments :
2880 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002881 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2883 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2884 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2885
2886 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2887 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2888 it exceeds <length>.
2889
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002890 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2892 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002893 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2894 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2895 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2896 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002897 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002898 environments to find where the request came from.
2899
2900 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2901 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2902 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2903 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002904
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002905 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2906 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2907 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2908 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2909 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002910
2911 Example:
2912 capture request header Host len 15
2913 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002914 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002916 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 about logging.
2918
2919
2920capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002921 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2923 no | yes | yes | no
2924 Arguments :
2925 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002926 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002927 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2928 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2929 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2930
2931 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2932 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2933 it exceeds <length>.
2934
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002935 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002936 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2937 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2938 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002939 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2940 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2941 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2942 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002943
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002944 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2945 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2946 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2947 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2948 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002949
2950 Example:
2951 capture response header Content-length len 9
2952 capture response header Location len 15
2953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002954 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002955 about logging.
2956
2957
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002958clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2961 yes | yes | yes | no
2962 Arguments :
2963 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2964 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2965 as explained at the top of this document.
2966
2967 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2968 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2969 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2970 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2971 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2972 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2973 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2974 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002975 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002977 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978
2979 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2980 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2981 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2982 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2983 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2984 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2985
2986 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2987 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2988
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002989 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2990 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002991
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002992compression algo <algorithm> ...
2993compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002994compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002995 Enable HTTP compression.
2996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2997 yes | yes | yes | yes
2998 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002999 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3000 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3001 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3002
3003 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003004 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3005 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3006 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003007
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003008 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003009 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003010
3011 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3012 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3013 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3014 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3015 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003016 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003017
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003018 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3019 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3020 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3021 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3022 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3023 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3024 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003025 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003026
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003027 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003028 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003029 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3030 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3031 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3032 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3033 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003034
3035 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3036 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3037 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3038 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3039 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003040 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3041 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3042 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3043 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3044 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003045 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3046 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003047
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003048 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003049 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3050 "Accept-Encoding" header
3051 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003052 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003053 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3054 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3055 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3056 "multipart"
3057 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3058 header
3059 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3060 and later
3061 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3062 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003063 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003064
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003065 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003066
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003067 Examples :
3068 compression algo gzip
3069 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003071
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003072contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | no | yes | yes
3076 Arguments :
3077 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3078 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3079 as explained at the top of this document.
3080
3081 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003082 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003083 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003084 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3086 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3087 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3088
3089 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3090 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3091 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3092 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3093 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3094 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3095
3096 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3097 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3098 instead.
3099
3100 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3101 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3102
3103
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003104cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003105 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3106 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003107 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3110 yes | no | yes | yes
3111 Arguments :
3112 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3113 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3114 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3115 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3116 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3117 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003118 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3120 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3121
3122 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3123 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3124 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3125 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3126 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3127 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003128 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3129 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003130 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003131 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3132 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003133
3134 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003135 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003136
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003137 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003138 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3139 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003140 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003141 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3142 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3143 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3144 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3145 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3146 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3147 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148
3149 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3150 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3151 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3152 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3153 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3154 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3155 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3156 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3157 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003158 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003159 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3160 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3161 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003163 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3164 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3165 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003166 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3167 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3168 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3169 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003170 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3171 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3172 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003173
3174 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3175 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3176 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3177 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3178 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3179 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3180 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3181 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3182 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3183
3184 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3185 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3186 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3187 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3188 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3189 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3190 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3191 persistence cookie in the cache.
3192 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3193
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003194 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3195 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3196 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3197 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3198 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003199 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003200 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3201 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3202 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3203 they logout.
3204
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003205 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3206 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3207 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3208 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3209
3210 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3211 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3212 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3213 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3214 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3215 this attribute.
3216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003217 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003218 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003219 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3220 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3221 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3222 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3223 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3224 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003225
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003226 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3227 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3228 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3229 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3230 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3231 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3232 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3233 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003234 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003235 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3236 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3237 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3238 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3239 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3240 the site.
3241
3242 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3243 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3244 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3245 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3246 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3247 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3248 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3249 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3250 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3251 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3252 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3253 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3254 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003255 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003256 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3257 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3258
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003259 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3260 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3261 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3262 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3263 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3264 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003266 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3267 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3268 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3269 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003271 Examples :
3272 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3273 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3274 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003275 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003276
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003277 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003279
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003280declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3281 Declares a capture slot.
3282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3283 no | yes | yes | no
3284 Arguments:
3285 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3286
3287 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3288 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3289 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3290 for use in the response.
3291
3292 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003293 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003294 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3295
3296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003297default-server [param*]
3298 Change default options for a server in a backend
3299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3300 yes | no | yes | yes
3301 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003302 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3303 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3304 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3305 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003306
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003307 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003308 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3309
3310 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003311
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003313default_backend <backend>
3314 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3316 yes | yes | yes | no
3317 Arguments :
3318 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3319
3320 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3321 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3322 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3323 will catch all undetermined requests.
3324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003325 Example :
3326
3327 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3328 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3329 default_backend dynamic
3330
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003331 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003334description <string>
3335 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3337 no | yes | yes | yes
3338 Arguments : string
3339
3340 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3341 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3342 it describes.
3343 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3344
3345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003346disabled
3347 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3349 yes | yes | yes | yes
3350 Arguments : none
3351
3352 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3353 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3354 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3355 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3356 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3357 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3358 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3359
3360 See also : "enabled"
3361
3362
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003363dispatch <address>:<port>
3364 Set a default server address
3365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3366 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003367 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003368
3369 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3370 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3371 during start-up.
3372
3373 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3374 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3375 possible with normal servers.
3376
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003377 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003378 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3379 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3380 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3381 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3382
3383 See also : "server"
3384
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003385
3386dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3387 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3389 yes | no | yes | yes
3390 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3391
3392 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003393 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003394 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3395 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003396 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003397 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003399enabled
3400 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3402 yes | yes | yes | yes
3403 Arguments : none
3404
3405 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3406 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3407
3408 See also : "disabled"
3409
3410
3411errorfile <code> <file>
3412 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 yes | yes | yes | yes
3415 Arguments :
3416 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003417 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3418 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419
3420 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003421 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003423 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3424 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
3426 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3427 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3428 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3429
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003430 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003432 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3433 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3434 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3435 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3436
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003437 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3438 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003439 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003440 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3441 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3442 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003444 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3445 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3446 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003447 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003448 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3449
3450 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3451
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003452 Example :
3453 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003454 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003455 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3456 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3457
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003458
3459errorloc <code> <url>
3460errorloc302 <code> <url>
3461 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 yes | yes | yes | yes
3464 Arguments :
3465 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003466 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3467 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003468
3469 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3470 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3471 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3472 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003473 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003474
3475 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3476 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3477 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3478
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003479 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3480
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003481 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3482 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3483 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3484 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003485 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003486 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3487 request.
3488
3489 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3490
3491
3492errorloc303 <code> <url>
3493 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 yes | yes | yes | yes
3496 Arguments :
3497 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003498 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3499 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003500
3501 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3502 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3503 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3504 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003505 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003506
3507 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3508 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3509 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3510
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003511 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3512
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003513 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3514 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3515 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3516 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003517 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003518
3519 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3520
3521
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003522email-alert from <emailaddr>
3523 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003524 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 yes | yes | yes | yes
3527
3528 Arguments :
3529
3530 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3531
3532 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3533 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3534
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003535 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003536 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3537 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003538
3539
3540email-alert level <level>
3541 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3542 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3543 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3544 yes | yes | yes | yes
3545
3546 Arguments :
3547
3548 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3549 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3550 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3551
3552 By default level is alert
3553
3554 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3555 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3556 for the proxy.
3557
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003558 Alerts are sent when :
3559
3560 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3561 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3562 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3563 is notice or lower
3564 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3565 and a health check status update occurs
3566
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003567 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3568 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003569 section 3.6 about mailers.
3570
3571
3572email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3573 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3575 yes | yes | yes | yes
3576
3577 Arguments :
3578
3579 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3580
3581 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3582 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3583
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003584 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3585 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003586
3587
3588email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3589 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3590 mailers.
3591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 yes | yes | yes | yes
3593
3594 Arguments :
3595
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003596 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003597
3598 By default the systems hostname is used.
3599
3600 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3601 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3602 for the proxy.
3603
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003604 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3605 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003606
3607
3608email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003609 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003610 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3612 yes | yes | yes | yes
3613
3614 Arguments :
3615
3616 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3617
3618 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3619 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3620
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003621 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003622 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3623
3624
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003625force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3626 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003628 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003629
3630 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3631 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3632 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3633 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3634 marked down for maintenance operations.
3635
3636 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3637 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3638 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3639 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3640 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3641 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3642 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3643 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3644 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3645
3646 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3647 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3648 is used.
3649
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003650 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003651 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003652
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003653
3654filter <name> [param*]
3655 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 no | yes | yes | yes
3658 Arguments :
3659 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3660 referenced in section 9.
3661
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003662 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003663 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003664 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3665 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003666
3667 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3668 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3669
3670 Example:
3671 listen
3672 bind *:80
3673
3674 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3675 filter compression
3676 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3677
3678 compression algo gzip
3679 compression offload
3680
3681 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3682
3683 See also : section 9.
3684
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003685
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003686fullconn <conns>
3687 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3689 yes | no | yes | yes
3690 Arguments :
3691 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3692 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3693
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003694 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003695 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003696 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003697 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3698 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3699 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3700 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3701 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003702 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003703
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003704 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3705 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003706 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3707 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3708 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003710 Example :
3711 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3712 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3713 # connections.
3714 backend dynamic
3715 fullconn 10000
3716 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3717 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3718
3719 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3720
3721
3722grace <time>
3723 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003726 Arguments :
3727 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3728 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3729 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3730
3731 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3732 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003733 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003734 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3735
3736 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3737 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3738 simplify it.
3739
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003740
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003741hash-balance-factor <factor>
3742 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3744 yes | no | no | yes
3745 Arguments :
3746 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3747 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003748 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003749
3750 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3751 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3752 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3753 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3754 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3755 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3756 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3757
3758 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3759 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3760 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3761 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3762 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3763
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003764 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3765 consistent hashing mechanism.
3766
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003767 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3768
3769
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003770hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003771 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3773 yes | no | yes | yes
3774 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003775 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3776 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003777
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003778 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3779 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3780 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3781 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3782 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3783 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3784 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3785 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3786 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3787 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003788
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003789 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3790 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3791 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3792 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3793 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3794 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3795 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3796 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3797 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3798 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3799 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3800 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3801 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003802 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3803 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003804
3805 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3806
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003807 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003808 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3809 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3810 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003811 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3812 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3813 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003814
3815 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3816 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003817 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3818 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3819 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3820 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3821
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003822 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3823 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3824 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3825 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3826 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3827 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3828 parameter.
3829
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003830 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3831 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3832 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3833 used on strings.
3834
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003835 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3836
3837 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3838 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3839 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3840 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3841 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3842 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3843 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3844 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3845 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3846 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3847 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3848 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003849
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003850 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3851 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3852 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003853
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003854 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003855
3856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003857http-check disable-on-404
3858 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003860 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003861 Arguments : none
3862
3863 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3864 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3865 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3866 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3867 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3868 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3869 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3870 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003871 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3872 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3873 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3874
3875 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3876
3877
3878http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003879 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003881 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003882 Arguments :
3883 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3884 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003885 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003886 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3887 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3888 details on the supported keywords.
3889
3890 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3891 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3892 with the usual backslash ('\').
3893
3894 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3895 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3896 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3897 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3898 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3899
3900 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003901 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003902 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3903 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3904 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3905
3906 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003907 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003908 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3909 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3910 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3911 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3912
3913 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003914 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003915 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3916 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3917 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3918 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3919 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003920 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003921 trace).
3922
3923 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003924 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003925 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3926 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3927 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3928 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3929 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003930 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003931
3932 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3933 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3934 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3935 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3936 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3937 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3938 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3939 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3940
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003941 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3942 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3943 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3944
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003945 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3946 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3947
3948 Examples :
3949 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003950 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003951
3952 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003953 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003954
3955 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003956 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003957
3958 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003959 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003961 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003962
3963
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003964http-check send-state
3965 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3967 yes | no | yes | yes
3968 Arguments : none
3969
3970 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3971 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3972 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3973 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3974 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3975
3976 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3977 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3978 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3979 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3980 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003981 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3982 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3983 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3984
3985 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3986 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3987 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3988
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003989 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3990 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3991 checked in multiple backends.
3992
3993 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3994 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3995
3996 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3997 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3998 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3999 one fails.
4000
4001 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4002 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4003 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4004
4005 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4006 server's queue.
4007
4008 Example of a header received by the application server :
4009 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4010 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4011
4012 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004014
4015http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004016 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4017
4018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4019 no | yes | yes | yes
4020
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004021 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4022 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4023 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4024 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4025 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004027 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4028 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004030 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004032 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4033 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4034 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4035 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004037 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4038 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4039 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4040 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004042 Example:
4043 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4044 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4045 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004047 http-request allow if nagios
4048 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4049 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4050 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004052 Example:
4053 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4054 acl add path /addacl
4055 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004057 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004059 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4060 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004062 Example:
4063 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4064 acl setmap path /setmap
4065 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004067 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004068
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004069 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4070 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004072 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4073 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004075http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004077 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4078 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4079 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4080 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4081 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4082 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4083 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4084 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004086http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004088 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4089 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4090 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4091 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4092 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4093 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4094 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4095 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004097http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004099 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4100 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004101
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004103http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004105 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4106 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4107 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4108 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4109 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004111 Example:
4112 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4113 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004114
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004115http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004117 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004119http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4120 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004122 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4123 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4124 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4125 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4126 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4127 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4128 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4129 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4130 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004132 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4133 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4134 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4135 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4136 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4137 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004139http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004141 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4142 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4143 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4144 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4145 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4146 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004148http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004150 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004152http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004154 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4155 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4156 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4157 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4158 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4159 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004163 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4164 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4165 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4166 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4167 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004168
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004169http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4170
4171 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4172 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4173 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4174 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004175 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4176 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004177
4178 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004180http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4183 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4184 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4185 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4186 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004188http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004190 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4191 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4192 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4193 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4196 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004198 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4199 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4200 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4201 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4202 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4203 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4204 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4205 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004207 Example:
4208 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004210 # applied to:
4211 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004213 # outputs:
4214 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004216 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004218http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4219 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004221 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4222 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4223 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4224 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004226 Example:
4227 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004229 # applied to:
4230 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232 # outputs:
4233 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4236http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004238 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4239 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4240 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4245 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4246 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004250 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4251 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4252 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4253 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4254 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256 Arguments:
4257 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4258 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004260 Example:
4261 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4262 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4265 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004267http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4270 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4271 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004273 Arguments:
4274 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4275 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004277 Example:
4278 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4279 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004281 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4282 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4283 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004285http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4288 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4289 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4290 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4291 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004293 Example:
4294 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4295 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4296 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4297 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4298 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4299 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4300 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4301 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4302 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4307 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4308 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4309 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4310 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4313 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004315 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4316 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4317 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4318 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4319 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4320 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4321 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4322 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4323 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4328 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4329 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4330 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4331 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4332 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4333 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4338 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4339 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004341http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004343 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4344 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4345 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4346 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4347 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4348 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4349 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4350 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004352http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004354 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4355 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4356 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4357 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4358 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4359 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004361 Example :
4362 # prepend the host name before the path
4363 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4368 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4369 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4370 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4371 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4376 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4377 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4378 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4379 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4380 values have higher priority.
4381 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4382 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4383 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4384 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4385 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004387http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4390 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4391 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4392 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4393 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4394 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4395 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004398
4399 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4401 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4404 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4405 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4406 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4407 privacy.
4408
4409 Arguments :
4410 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4411 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004412
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004413 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004414 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4415 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4416
4417 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4418 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4419
4420http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4421
4422 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4423 expression.
4424
4425 Arguments:
4426 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4427 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004428
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004429 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4431 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4432
4433 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4434 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4435 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4436
4437http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4438
4439 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4440 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4441 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4442 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4443 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4444 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4445 information from the request.
4446
4447 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4448
4449http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4450
4451 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4452 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4453 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4454 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4455 path and the query string.
4456 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4457
4458http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4459
4460 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4461 inline.
4462
4463 Arguments:
4464 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4465 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4466 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4467 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4468 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4469 (request and response)
4470 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4471 processing
4472 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4473 processing
4474 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4475 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4476 and '_'.
4477
4478 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4479 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004480
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004481 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004484http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4485 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004487 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4488 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4489 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4490 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4491 agent name must be used.
4492
4493 Arguments:
4494 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4495
4496 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4497 configuration.
4498
4499http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4500
4501 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4502 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4503 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4504 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4505 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4506 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4507 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4508 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4509 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4510 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4511 action.
4512 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4513 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4514 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4515 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4516 you fully understand how it works.
4517
4518http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4519
4520 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4521 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4522 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4523 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4524 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4525 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4526 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4527 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4528 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4529 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4530 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4531 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4532 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4533
4534http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4535http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4536http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4537
4538 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4539 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4540 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4541 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4542 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4543 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4544 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4545 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4546 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4547 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4548 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4549 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4550
4551 Arguments :
4552 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4553 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4554 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4555 select which table entry to update the counters.
4556
4557 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4558 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4559 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4560 that table until the session ends.
4561
4562 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4563 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4564 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4565 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4566 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4567 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4568 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4569 useful information.
4570
4571 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4572 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4573 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4574 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4575 checks that make use of it.
4576
4577http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4578
4579 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004580
4581 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004584http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4587 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4588 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004589
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004590
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004591http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004592 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4593
4594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 no | yes | yes | yes
4596
4597 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4598 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4599 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4600 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4601 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4602 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4603
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004604 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4605 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004606
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004607 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004608
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004609 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4610 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4611 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4612 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004613
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004614 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4615 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4616 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4617 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004619 Example:
4620 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004621
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004622 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004623
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004624 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4625 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004627 Example:
4628 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004629
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004630 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004631
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004632 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4633 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004634
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004635 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4636 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004637
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004638http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004639
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004640 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4641 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4642 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4643 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4644 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4645 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4646 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4647 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004648
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004649http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004650
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004651 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4652 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4653 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4654 example, or to pass some internal information.
4655 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4656 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4657 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004658
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004659http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004661 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4662 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004663
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004664http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004666 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004667
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004668http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004669
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004670 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4671 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4672 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4673 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4674 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4675 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4676 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004678 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4679 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4680 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4681 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4682 keyword.
4683 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4684 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004685
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004686http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004688 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4689 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4690 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4691 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4692 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4693 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004695http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004696
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004697 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004698
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004699http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004701 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4702 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4703 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4704 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4705 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4706 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004707
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004708http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004709
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004710 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4711 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004712
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004713http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004715 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4716 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4717 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4718 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4719 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4720 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004722http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4723 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004724
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004725 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4726 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4727 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4728 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4729 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4730 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4731 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4732 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004733
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004734 Example:
4735 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004736
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004737 # applied to:
4738 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004740 # outputs:
4741 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004743 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004744
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004745http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4746 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004747
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004748 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4749 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4750 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4751 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004753 Example:
4754 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004755
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004756 # applied to:
4757 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004759 # outputs:
4760 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004762http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4763http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004764
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004765 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4766 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4767 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004768
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004769http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004770
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004771 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4772 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4773 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004774
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004775http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004776
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004777 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4778 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4779 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4780 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4781 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004782
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004783 Arguments:
4784 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004785
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004786 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4787 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004789http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004791 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4792 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4793 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004795http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4796
4797 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4798 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4799 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4800 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4801 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4802
4803http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4804
4805 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4806 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4807 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4808 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4809 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4810 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4811 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4812 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4813 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4814
4815http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4816
4817 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4818 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4819 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4820 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4821 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4822 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4823 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4824
4825http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4826
4827 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4828 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4829 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4830 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4831 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4832 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4833 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4834 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4835
4836http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4837 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4838
4839 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4840 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4841 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4842 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004843
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004844 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004845 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4846 http-response set-status 431
4847 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4848 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004849
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004850http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004852 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4853 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4854 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4855 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4856 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4857 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4858 based on some information from the request.
4859
4860 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4861
4862http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4863
4864 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4865 inline.
4866
4867 Arguments:
4868 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4869 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4870 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4871 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4872 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4873 (request and response)
4874 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4875 processing
4876 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4877 processing
4878 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4879 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4880 and '_'.
4881
4882 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4883 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004884
4885 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004887
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004888http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004890 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4891 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4892 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4893 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4894 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4895 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4896 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4897 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4898 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4899 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4900 action.
4901 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4902 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4903 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4904 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4905 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004907http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4908http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4909http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004911 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4912 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4913 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4914 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4915 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4916 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4917
4918http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4919
4920 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4921 about <var-name>.
4922
4923 Example:
4924 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4925
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004926
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004927http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4928 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4929
4930 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4931 yes | no | yes | yes
4932
4933 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004934 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
4935 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
4936 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004937
4938 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4939
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004940 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
4941 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
4942 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
4943 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
4944 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
4945 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
4946 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
4947 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
4948 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
4949 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004950
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004951 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
4952 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
4953 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
4954 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
4955 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
4956 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
4957 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
4958 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004959
4960 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4961 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4962 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4963 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4964 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4965 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4966 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4967 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4968 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4969 downsides of rare connection failures.
4970
4971 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4972 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4973 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4974 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4975 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4976 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004977 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004978 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4979 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4980 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4981 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4982 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4983
4984 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004985 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4986 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4987 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004988
4989 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004990 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004991
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02004992 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
4993 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004994
4995 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4996 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4997 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4998
4999 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5000 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5001 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5002
5003 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5004
5005
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005006http-send-name-header [<header>]
5007 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5008
5009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 yes | no | yes | yes
5011
5012 Arguments :
5013
5014 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5015
5016 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005017 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005018 is added with the header string proved.
5019
5020 See also : "server"
5021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005022id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005023 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5025 no | yes | yes | yes
5026 Arguments : none
5027
5028 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5029 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5030 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005031
5032
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005033ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5034 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5035 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005036 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005037
5038 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5039 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5040 and running).
5041
5042 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5043 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5044 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005045 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005046 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5047
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005048 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5049 "unless" condition is met.
5050
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005051 Example:
5052 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5053 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5054 ignore-persist if url_static
5055
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005056 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5057
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005058load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5059 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5061 yes | no | yes | yes
5062
5063 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5064 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5065 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005066 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005067 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5068 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5069 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5070 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5071
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005072 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005073 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005074 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005075
5076 Arguments:
5077 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5078 named "server-state-file".
5079
5080 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5081 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5082 name is used as a file name.
5083
5084 none don't load any stat for this backend
5085
5086 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005087 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5088 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5089 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005090 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005091 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005092
5093 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5094 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5095
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005096 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005097
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005098 global
5099 stats socket /tmp/socket
5100 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005101
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005102 defaults
5103 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005104
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005105 backend bk
5106 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5107 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005108
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005109
5110 Then one can run :
5111
5112 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5113
5114 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5115
5116 1
5117 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5118 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5119 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5120
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005121 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005122
5123 global
5124 stats socket /tmp/socket
5125 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5126
5127 defaults
5128 load-server-state-from-file local
5129
5130 backend bk
5131 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5132 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5133
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005134
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005135 Then one can run :
5136
5137 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5138
5139 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5140
5141 1
5142 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5143 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5144 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5145
5146 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5147 "show servers state"
5148
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005149
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005150log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005151log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005152no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005153 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5155 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005156
5157 Prefix :
5158 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5159 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5160 prefix does not allow arguments.
5161
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005162 Arguments :
5163 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5164 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5165 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5166 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5167 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5168 parameter.
5169
5170 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5171 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5172
5173 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5174 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5175 standard syslog port).
5176
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005177 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5178 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5179 standard syslog port).
5180
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005181 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5182 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5183 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005184 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005185
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005186 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5187 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5188 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5189 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5190 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5191 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5192 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5193 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5194 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5195 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5196 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5197 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5198 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5199 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5200 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5201 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005202 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5203 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005204
5205 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5206 and "fd@2", see above.
5207
5208 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5209 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005210
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005211 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5212 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5213 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5214 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5215 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5216 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5217 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5218 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5219 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5220 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005221 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005222
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005223 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5224 one of the following :
5225
5226 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5227 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5228
5229 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5230 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5231
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005232 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5233 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5234 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5235 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5236 systemd logger consumes.
5237
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005238 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5239 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5240 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5241 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005243 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5244
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005245 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5246 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5247 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5248
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005249 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5250 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5251 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5252 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005253
5254 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5255 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5256 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005257 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5258 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5259 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5260 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5261 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005262
5263 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5264
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005265 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5266 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5267 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005268
5269 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5270 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5271 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5272 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5273
5274 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5275 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005276
5277 Example :
5278 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005279 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5280 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5281 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005282 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5283 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005284 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005285
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005286
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005287log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005288 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5290 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005291
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005292 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5293 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5294 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5295 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5296 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005297
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005298 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5299 "option httplog" directives.
5300
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005301log-format-sd <string>
5302 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | yes | yes | no
5305
5306 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5307 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5308 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5309 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5310 which covers the log format string in depth.
5311
5312 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5313 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5314
5315 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5316 log format to "rfc5424".
5317
5318 Example :
5319 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5320
5321
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005322log-tag <string>
5323 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | yes | yes | yes
5326
5327 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5328 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5329 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5330 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5331 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5332 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5333 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5334 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5335 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005336
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005337max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5338 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5339 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5340 yes | no | yes | yes
5341
5342 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5343 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5344 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5345 servers.
5346
5347 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5348 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5349 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5350 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5351 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005352 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005353 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5354 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5355 picking a different server.
5356
5357 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5358 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5359 even if they have to be queued.
5360
5361 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5362 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5363
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005364max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5365 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5366 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5367 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005368
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005369maxconn <conns>
5370 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5372 yes | yes | yes | no
5373 Arguments :
5374 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5375 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5376 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5377 closes.
5378
5379 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5380 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5381 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5382 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005383 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5384 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5385 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5386 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005387
5388 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5389 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5390 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5391
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005392 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5393 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005394
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005395 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5396
5397
5398mode { tcp|http|health }
5399 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5401 yes | yes | yes | yes
5402 Arguments :
5403 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5404 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5405 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5406 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5407
5408 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5409 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5410 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5411 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5412 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5413
5414 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005415 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5416 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5417 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5418 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5419 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5420 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5421 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005422
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005423 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5424 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5425 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005426
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005427 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005428 defaults http_instances
5429 mode http
5430
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005431 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005433
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005434monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005435 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005438 Arguments :
5439 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5440 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005441 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005442 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5443 backend and its backup.
5444
5445 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5446 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5447 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5448 servers in a list of backends.
5449
5450 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5451 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5452 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5453 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5454 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5455 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5456 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005457 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5458 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005459
5460 Example:
5461 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005462 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005463 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5464 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5465 monitor-uri /site_alive
5466 monitor fail if site_dead
5467
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005468 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005469
5470
5471monitor-net <source>
5472 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5474 yes | yes | yes | no
5475 Arguments :
5476 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5477 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5478 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5479 followed by a mask.
5480
5481 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5482 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005483 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005484 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5485
5486 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5487 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5488 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5489 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005490 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5491 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5492 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005493
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005494 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5495 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5496 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5497 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5498 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5499 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005500
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005501 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5502 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005504 Example :
5505 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5506 frontend www
5507 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5508
5509 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5510
5511
5512monitor-uri <uri>
5513 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5515 yes | yes | yes | no
5516 Arguments :
5517 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5518 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5519
5520 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5521 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5522 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5523 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5524 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5525 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5526 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5527 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5528
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005529 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5530 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5531 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5532 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5533 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5534 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5535 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5536 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005537
5538 Example :
5539 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5540 frontend www
5541 mode http
5542 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5543
5544 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5545
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005546
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005547option abortonclose
5548no option abortonclose
5549 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5551 yes | no | yes | yes
5552 Arguments : none
5553
5554 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5555 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5556 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5557 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005558 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005559 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5560 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5561 encountered while delivering the response.
5562
5563 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5564 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5565 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5566 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5567 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5568 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005569 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005570 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005571 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005572 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5573 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5574 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5575
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005576 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5577 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005578 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5579 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5580 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5581 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5582 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5583 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005584 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005585
5586 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5587 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5588
5589 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5590
5591
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005592option accept-invalid-http-request
5593no option accept-invalid-http-request
5594 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5596 yes | yes | yes | no
5597 Arguments : none
5598
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005599 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005600 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005601 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005602 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5603 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5604 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5605 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5606 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005607 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5608 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5609 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5610 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005611 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005612 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005613 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5614 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5615 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005616
5617 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5618 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5619 been confirmed.
5620
5621 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5622 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005623 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5624 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005625 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5626
5627 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5628 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5629
5630 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5631 stats socket.
5632
5633
5634option accept-invalid-http-response
5635no option accept-invalid-http-response
5636 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5638 yes | no | yes | yes
5639 Arguments : none
5640
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005641 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005642 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005643 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005644 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5645 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5646 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5647 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5648 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005649 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5650 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5651 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005652
5653 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5654 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5655 been confirmed.
5656
5657 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5658 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5659 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5660 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5661
5662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5664
5665 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5666 stats socket.
5667
5668
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005669option allbackups
5670no option allbackups
5671 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5673 yes | no | yes | yes
5674 Arguments : none
5675
5676 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5677 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5678 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5679 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5680 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5681 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5682 order between the backup servers anymore.
5683
5684 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5685 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5686
5687 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5688 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5689
5690
5691option checkcache
5692no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005693 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5695 yes | no | yes | yes
5696 Arguments : none
5697
5698 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5699 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005700 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005701 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5702 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005703 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005704
5705 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005706 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005707 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005708 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5709 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005710 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005711 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005712 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5713 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005714 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005715 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5716 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005717 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005718 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5719 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5720 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5721 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5722 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5723 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5724 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5725 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5726 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5727
5728 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005729 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005730 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005731 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005732 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5733
5734 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5735 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005736 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005737 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005738
5739 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5740 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5741
5742
5743option clitcpka
5744no option clitcpka
5745 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | yes | yes | no
5748 Arguments : none
5749
5750 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5751 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005752 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005753 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5754
5755 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5756 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5757 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5758 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5759
5760 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5761 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5762 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5763 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5764 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5765
5766 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5767
5768 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5769 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5770 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5771
5772 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5773 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5774
5775 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5776
5777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005778option contstats
5779 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5781 yes | yes | yes | no
5782 Arguments : none
5783
5784 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5785 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5786 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5787 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005788 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5789 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5790 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5791 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5792 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005793
5794
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005795option dontlog-normal
5796no option dontlog-normal
5797 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | yes | yes | no
5800 Arguments : none
5801
5802 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5803 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5804 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5805 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5806 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5807 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5808 logged.
5809
5810 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5811 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5812 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005814 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005815 logging.
5816
5817
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005818option dontlognull
5819no option dontlognull
5820 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5822 yes | yes | yes | no
5823 Arguments : none
5824
5825 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5826 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5827 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5828 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5829 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5830 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005831 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5832 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5833 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005834
5835 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005836 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005837 would not be logged.
5838
5839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5841
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005842 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5843 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005844
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005845
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005846option forceclose (deprecated)
5847no option forceclose (deprecated)
5848 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005849
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005850 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005851
5852
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005853option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005854 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5856 yes | yes | yes | yes
5857 Arguments :
5858 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5859 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005860 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005861 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005862
5863 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5864 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5865 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5866 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5867 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5868 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5869 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005870 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5871 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5872 possible that the client has already brought one.
5873
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005874 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005875 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005876 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005877 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005878 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005879 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005880
5881 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5882 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5883 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5884 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5885 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5886 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5887 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5888
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005889 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5890 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5891 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5892 are under the control of the end-user.
5893
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005894 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005895 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5896 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005897 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5898 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5899 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005900
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005901 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005902 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5903 frontend www
5904 mode http
5905 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5906
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005907 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5908 backend www
5909 mode http
5910 option forwardfor header X-Client
5911
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005912 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005913 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005914
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005915
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005916option http-buffer-request
5917no option http-buffer-request
5918 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | yes | yes | yes
5921 Arguments : none
5922
5923 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5924 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5925 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5926 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5927 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5928 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5929 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5930 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005931 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005932 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5933 default.
5934
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005935 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005936
5937
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005938option http-ignore-probes
5939no option http-ignore-probes
5940 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5942 yes | yes | yes | no
5943 Arguments : none
5944
5945 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5946 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5947 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5948 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5949 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5950 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5951 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5952 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5953 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005954 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5955 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005956 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5957
5958 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5959 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5960 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5961 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5962 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5963 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5964 are often the only way to detect them.
5965
5966 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5967 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5968
5969 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5970
5971
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005972option http-keep-alive
5973no option http-keep-alive
5974 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5976 yes | yes | yes | yes
5977 Arguments : none
5978
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005979 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5980 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005981 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5982 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5983 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
5984 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
5985 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005986
5987 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5988 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005989 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5990 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5991 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5992 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5993 situations where this option may be useful :
5994
5995 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005996 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005997
5998 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5999 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6000
6001 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6002 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6003 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6004 request.
6005
6006 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6007 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006008 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6009 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6010 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006011
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006012 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6013 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6014 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6015 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6016 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6017 not set.
6018
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006019 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006020 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6021 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006022
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006023 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006024 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006025 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006026
6027
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006028option http-no-delay
6029no option http-no-delay
6030 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6032 yes | yes | yes | yes
6033 Arguments : none
6034
6035 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6036 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6037 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6038 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6039 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6040 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6041 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6042 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6043 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6044 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6045 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6046 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6047 affected.
6048
6049 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6050 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6051 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6052 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6053 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6054 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6055 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6056 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6057 latency environments.
6058
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006059 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6060
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006061
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006062option http-pretend-keepalive
6063no option http-pretend-keepalive
6064 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006066 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006067 Arguments : none
6068
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006069 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006070 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6071 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6072 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6073 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6074 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6075 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6076 consider the response complete.
6077
6078 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6079 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6080 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6081 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006082 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006083 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6084
6085 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6086 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6087 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6088 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6089 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6090 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6091 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6092
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006093 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6094 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6095 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6096 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6097 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6098 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006099
6100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6102
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006103 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006104 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006105
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006106
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006107option http-server-close
6108no option http-server-close
6109 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6111 yes | yes | yes | yes
6112 Arguments : none
6113
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006114 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6115 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6116 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6117 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006118 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6119 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6120 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6121 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6122 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6123 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6124 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6125 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6126 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6127 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6128 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006129
6130 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6131 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6132 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6133 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006134 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6135 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006136
6137 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6138 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006139 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6140 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6141 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006142
6143 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6144 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6145
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006146 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6147 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006148
6149
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006150option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6151no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6152 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006154 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006155 Arguments : none
6156
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006157 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6158 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6159 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6160
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006161 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6162 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6163 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6164 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006165 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006166
6167 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006168 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006169 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6170 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6171 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6172 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6173 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6174 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6175 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006176
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006177 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6178 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6179 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6180 backend.
6181
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006182 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6183 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006185 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6186 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006187
6188
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006189option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006190no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006191 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6193 yes | yes | yes | no
6194 Arguments : none
6195
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006196 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006197 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6198 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6199 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6200 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6201 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6202 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6203
6204 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6205 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006206 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6207 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6208 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006209
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006210 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6211 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6212 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6213 front of an existing proxy.
6214
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006215 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6216
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006217 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006218
6219
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006220option http-use-htx
6221no option http-use-htx
6222 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6224 yes | yes | yes | yes
6225 Arguments : none
6226
6227 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6228 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6229 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6230 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6231 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6232 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6233 representation.
6234
6235 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6236 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6237 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6238 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6239 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6240 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6241 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6242 other side's version.
6243
6244 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6245 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6246 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6247 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6248 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6249
6250 See also : "mode http"
6251
6252
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006253option httpchk
6254option httpchk <uri>
6255option httpchk <method> <uri>
6256option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6257 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6259 yes | no | yes | yes
6260 Arguments :
6261 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6262 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6263 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6264 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6265 ones.
6266
6267 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6268 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6269 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6270
6271 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6272 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6273 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6274 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6275 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6276
6277 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6278 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6279 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6280 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6281 the lack of any response.
6282
6283 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6284
6285 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6286 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6287 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6288
6289 Examples :
6290 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6291 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6292 backend https_relay
6293 mode tcp
6294 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6295 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6296
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006297 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6298 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6299 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006300
6301
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006302option httpclose
6303no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006304 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6306 yes | yes | yes | yes
6307 Arguments : none
6308
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006309 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6310 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6311 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6312 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006313 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006314
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006315 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6316 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6317 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6318 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6319 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006320
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006321 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6322 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6323 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006324
6325 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6326 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006327 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006328 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6329 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6330 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006331
6332 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6333 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6334
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006335 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006336
6337
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006338option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006339 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006341 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006342 Arguments :
6343 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6344 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6345 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006346 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006347 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006348
6349 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6350 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6351 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6352 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6353 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6354 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6355 ports.
6356
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006357 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6358 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006359
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006360 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006362 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006363
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006364
6365option http_proxy
6366no option http_proxy
6367 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6369 yes | yes | yes | yes
6370 Arguments : none
6371
6372 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6373 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6374 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6375 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6376 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6377
6378 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6379 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006380 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6381 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006382
6383 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6384 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6385
6386 Example :
6387 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6388 backend direct_forward
6389 option httpclose
6390 option http_proxy
6391
6392 See also : "option httpclose"
6393
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006394
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006395option independent-streams
6396no option independent-streams
6397 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | yes | yes | yes
6400 Arguments : none
6401
6402 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6403 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6404 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6405 receive data or not.
6406
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006407 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006408 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6409 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6410 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6411 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6412 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6413 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6414 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6415 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6416 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6417 socket buffers.
6418
6419 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6420 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6421 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6422 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6423 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6424
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006425 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006426 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6427 deprecated.
6428
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006429 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006430
6431
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006432option ldap-check
6433 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6435 yes | no | yes | yes
6436 Arguments : none
6437
6438 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6439 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6440 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6441 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6442
6443 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6444 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6445
6446 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6447 configure it.
6448
6449 Example :
6450 option ldap-check
6451
6452 See also : "option httpchk"
6453
6454
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006455option external-check
6456 Use external processes for server health checks
6457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6458 yes | no | yes | yes
6459
6460 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6461 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6462 command".
6463
6464 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6465
6466 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6467
6468
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006469option log-health-checks
6470no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006471 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6473 yes | no | yes | yes
6474 Arguments : none
6475
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006476 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6477 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6478 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006479
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006480 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6481 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6482 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6483 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6484 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6485
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006486 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006487 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006488
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006489 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6490 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6491 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006492
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006493
6494option log-separate-errors
6495no option log-separate-errors
6496 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6498 yes | yes | yes | no
6499 Arguments : none
6500
6501 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6502 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6503 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6504 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6505 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6506 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6507 provides very important information.
6508
6509 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6510 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6511 error logs.
6512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006513 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006514 logging.
6515
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006516
6517option logasap
6518no option logasap
6519 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | yes | yes | no
6522 Arguments : none
6523
6524 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6525 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6526 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6527 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6528 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6529 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6530 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006531 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006532 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6533 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6534
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006535 Examples :
6536 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6537 mode http
6538 option httplog
6539 option logasap
6540 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6541
6542 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6543 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6544 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6545 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006547 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006548 logging.
6549
6550
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006551option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006552 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6554 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006555 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006556 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6557 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006558 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006559
6560 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6561 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006562 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006563 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6564 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6565 in the MySQL table, like this :
6566
6567 USE mysql;
6568 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6569 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6570
6571 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006572 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006573 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6574 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6575 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6576 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6577 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6578 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6579 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6580
6581 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6582 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006583
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006584 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006585
6586 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6587 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6588 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6589 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006590 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6591 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006592
6593 See also: "option httpchk"
6594
6595
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006596option nolinger
6597no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006598 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6600 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006601 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006602
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006603 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006604 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6605 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6606 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6607 connections.
6608
6609 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6610 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6611 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6612 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6613 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6614 this too.
6615
6616 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6617 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6618 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6619
6620 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6621 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6622 for servers.
6623
6624 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6625 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6626
6627
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006628option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6629 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | yes | yes | yes
6632 Arguments :
6633 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6634 matching <network>
6635 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6636 header name.
6637
6638 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6639 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6640 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6641 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6642 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6643 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6644 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6645 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6646 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6647 possible that the client has already brought one.
6648
6649 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6650 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6651 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6652 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6653 header and requires different one.
6654
6655 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6656 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6657 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6658 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6659 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6660 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6661 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6662
6663 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6664 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6665 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6666 both are defined.
6667
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006668 Examples :
6669 # Original Destination address
6670 frontend www
6671 mode http
6672 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6673
6674 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6675 backend www
6676 mode http
6677 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6678
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006679 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006680
6681
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006682option persist
6683no option persist
6684 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6685 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6686 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006687 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006688
6689 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6690 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6691 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6692 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6693 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6694 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6695 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6696 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6697 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6698 redirected to another valid server.
6699
6700 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6701 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6702
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006703 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006704
6705
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006706option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6707 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6709 yes | no | yes | yes
6710 Arguments :
6711 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6712 PostgreSQL server.
6713
6714 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6715 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6716 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6717 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6718
6719 See also: "option httpchk"
6720
6721
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006722option prefer-last-server
6723no option prefer-last-server
6724 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6726 yes | no | yes | yes
6727 Arguments : none
6728
6729 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6730 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6731 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6732 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6733 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6734 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6735 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6736 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6737 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006738 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6739 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006740 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6741 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6742 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006743 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6744 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6745 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006746
6747 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6748 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6749
6750 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6751
6752
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006753option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006754option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006755no option redispatch
6756 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6758 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006759 Arguments :
6760 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6761 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6762 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006763 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006764 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006765 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006766 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6767 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6768 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006770
6771 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6772 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6773 be able to access the service anymore.
6774
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006775 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6776 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006777
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006778 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006779 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6780 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006782 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6783 "redisp" keywords.
6784
6785 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6786 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6787
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006788 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006789
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006790
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006791option redis-check
6792 Use redis health checks for server testing
6793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6794 yes | no | yes | yes
6795 Arguments : none
6796
6797 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6798 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6799 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6800 find the "+PONG" response message.
6801
6802 Example :
6803 option redis-check
6804
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006805 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006806
6807
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006808option smtpchk
6809option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6810 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6812 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006813 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006814 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006815 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006816 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6817
6818 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6819 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6820 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6821
6822 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6823 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6824 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6825 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6826 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6827 dead server.
6828
6829 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6830 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006831 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006832 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6833
6834 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6835 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6836 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6837 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006838 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006839
6840 Example :
6841 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6842
6843 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006846option socket-stats
6847no option socket-stats
6848
6849 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6851 yes | yes | yes | no
6852
6853 Arguments : none
6854
6855
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006856option splice-auto
6857no option splice-auto
6858 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6860 yes | yes | yes | yes
6861 Arguments : none
6862
6863 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6864 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006865 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006866 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006867 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006868 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6869 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6870 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6871 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6872
6873 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6874 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6875 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6876 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6877 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6878 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6879 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6880 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6881 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6882 keyword.
6883
6884 Example :
6885 option splice-auto
6886
6887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6889
6890 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6891 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6892
6893
6894option splice-request
6895no option splice-request
6896 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6898 yes | yes | yes | yes
6899 Arguments : none
6900
6901 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006902 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006903 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6904 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6905 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6906 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6907
6908 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6909
6910 Example :
6911 option splice-request
6912
6913 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6914 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6915
6916 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6917 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6918
6919
6920option splice-response
6921no option splice-response
6922 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6924 yes | yes | yes | yes
6925 Arguments : none
6926
6927 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006928 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006929 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6930 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6931 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6932 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6933
6934 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6935
6936 Example :
6937 option splice-response
6938
6939 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6940 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6941
6942 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6943 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6944
6945
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006946option spop-check
6947 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6949 no | no | no | yes
6950 Arguments : none
6951
6952 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6953 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6954 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6955 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6956
6957 Example :
6958 option spop-check
6959
6960 See also : "option httpchk"
6961
6962
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006963option srvtcpka
6964no option srvtcpka
6965 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6967 yes | no | yes | yes
6968 Arguments : none
6969
6970 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6971 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006972 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006973 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6974
6975 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6976 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6977 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6978 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6979
6980 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6981 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6982 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6983 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6984 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6985
6986 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6987
6988 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6989 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6990 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6991
6992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6994
6995 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6996
6997
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006998option ssl-hello-chk
6999 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 yes | no | yes | yes
7002 Arguments : none
7003
7004 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7005 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7006 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7007 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7008 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7009 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7010 hello message.
7011
7012 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7013 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7014 messages, which is appreciable.
7015
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007016 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7017 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7018 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007019
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007020 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7021
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007022
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007023option tcp-check
7024 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7026 yes | no | yes | yes
7027
7028 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7029 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7030
7031 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7032 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7033 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7034
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007035 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007036 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7037 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7038 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7039 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7040 only.
7041
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007042 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007043 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7044 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7045 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7046 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7047
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007048 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007049 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7050 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007051 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007052 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7053 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7054 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7055 the respective protocols.
7056 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007057 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007058
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007059 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7060 script.
7061
7062 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7063 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7064 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7065 The "comment" is of course optional.
7066
7067
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007068 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007069 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007070 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007071 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007072
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007073 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007074 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007075 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007076
7077 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7078 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007079 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007080 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007081 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007082 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007083 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007084 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007085 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7086 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007087 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007088 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7089 tcp-check expect string +OK
7090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007091 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007092 (send many headers before analyzing)
7093 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007094 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007095 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7096 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7097 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7098 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007099 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007100
7101
7102 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7103
7104
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007105option tcp-smart-accept
7106no option tcp-smart-accept
7107 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7109 yes | yes | yes | no
7110 Arguments : none
7111
7112 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7113 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7114 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7115 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7116 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7117 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7118
7119 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7120 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7121 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7122 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7123
7124 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7125 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7126 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007127 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007128
7129 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7130 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7131 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7132
7133 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7134 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7135 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7136
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007137 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7138
7139
7140option tcp-smart-connect
7141no option tcp-smart-connect
7142 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7144 yes | no | yes | yes
7145 Arguments : none
7146
7147 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7148 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7149 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7150 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7151 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7152
7153 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7154 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7155 complex.
7156
7157 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7158 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7159 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7160
7161 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7162 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7163
7164 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7165
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007166
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007167option tcpka
7168 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7170 yes | yes | yes | yes
7171 Arguments : none
7172
7173 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7174 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007175 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007176 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7177
7178 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7179 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7180 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7181 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7182
7183 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7184 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7185 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7186 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7187 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7188
7189 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7190
7191 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7192 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7193 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7194 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7195 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7196 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7197 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7198 backends.
7199
7200 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7201
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007202
7203option tcplog
7204 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007206 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007207 Arguments : none
7208
7209 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7210 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7211 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7212 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7213 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7214 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7215 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7216 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7217
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007218 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007220 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007221
7222
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007223option transparent
7224no option transparent
7225 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007227 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007228 Arguments : none
7229
7230 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7231 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7232 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7233 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7234 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7235 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7236 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7237 appropriate server.
7238
7239 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7240 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7241
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007242 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007243 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007244
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007245
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007246external-check command <command>
7247 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7249 yes | no | yes | yes
7250
7251 Arguments :
7252 <command> is the external command to run
7253
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007254 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7255
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007256 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007257
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007258 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7259 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7260 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7261 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7262 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7263 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007264
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007265 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7266
7267 Environment variables :
7268 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7269 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7270
7271 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7272
7273 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7274
7275 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7276 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7277 for a UNIX socket).
7278
7279 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7280
7281 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7282
7283 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7284
7285 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7286
7287 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7288
7289 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7290 socket).
7291
7292 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7293 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7294
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007295 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7296 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7297 failed.
7298
7299 Example :
7300 external-check command /bin/true
7301
7302 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7303
7304
7305external-check path <path>
7306 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7308 yes | no | yes | yes
7309
7310 Arguments :
7311 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7312
7313 The default path is "".
7314
7315 Example :
7316 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7317
7318 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7319 "external-check command"
7320
7321
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007322persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007323persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007324 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7326 yes | no | yes | yes
7327 Arguments :
7328 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007329 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7330 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007331
7332 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7333 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007334 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007335 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7336 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7337 forwarded to this server.
7338
7339 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7340 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7341 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007342 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007343 a single "listen" section.
7344
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007345 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7346 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7347 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7348
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007349 Example :
7350 listen tse-farm
7351 bind :3389
7352 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7353 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7354 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7355 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7356 persist rdp-cookie
7357 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007358 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007359 balance rdp-cookie
7360 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7361 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7362
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007363 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7364 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007365
7366
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007367rate-limit sessions <rate>
7368 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7370 yes | yes | yes | no
7371 Arguments :
7372 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7373 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7374
7375 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7376 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7377 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7378 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7379 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7380 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7381
7382 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7383 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7384 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7385 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7386
7387 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7388 listen smtp
7389 mode tcp
7390 bind :25
7391 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007392 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007393
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007394 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7395 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7396 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007397
7398 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7399
7400
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007401redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7402redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7403redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007404 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7406 no | yes | yes | yes
7407
7408 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007409 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007410
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007411 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007412 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007413 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7414 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7415 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007416
7417 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7418 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7419 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7420 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7421 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007422 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7423 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7424 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7425 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007426
7427 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7428 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7429 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7430 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7431 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7432 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007433 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007434 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007435 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7436 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7437 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007438
7439 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007440 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7441 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7442 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007443 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007444 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7445 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7446 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7447 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007448
7449 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007450 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007451
7452 - "drop-query"
7453 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7454 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7455 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7456 with a location-type redirect.
7457
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007458 - "append-slash"
7459 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7460 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7461 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7462 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7463
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007464 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7465 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7466 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7467 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7468 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7469 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7470 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7471
7472 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7473 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7474 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7475 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7476 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7477 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7478 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007479
7480 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7481 acl clear dst_port 80
7482 acl secure dst_port 8080
7483 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007484 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007485 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007486 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7487
7488 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007489 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7490 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7491 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007492 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007493
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007494 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7495 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7496 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7497
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007498 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007499 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007500
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007501 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007502 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7503 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7504 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007506 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007507
7508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007509redisp (deprecated)
7510redispatch (deprecated)
7511 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7512 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7513 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007514 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007515
7516 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7517 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7518 be able to access the service anymore.
7519
7520 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7521 redistribute them to a working server.
7522
7523 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7524 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7525 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007527 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7528 "option redispatch" instead.
7529
7530 See also : "option redispatch"
7531
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007532
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007533reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007534 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7536 no | yes | yes | yes
7537 Arguments :
7538 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7539 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007540 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007541
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007542 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7543 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7544
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007545 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7546 the last header of an HTTP request.
7547
7548 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7549 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7550 responses.
7551
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007552 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7553 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7554 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7555
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007556 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7557 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007558
7559
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007560reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7561reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007562 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7564 no | yes | yes | yes
7565 Arguments :
7566 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7567 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7568 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7569 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7570 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7571 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7572 ignores case.
7573
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007574 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7575 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7576
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007577 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7578 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7579 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7580 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007581 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007582
7583 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7584 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7585
7586 Example :
7587 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7588 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7589 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7590
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007591 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7592 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007593
7594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007595reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7596reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007597 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 no | yes | yes | yes
7600 Arguments :
7601 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7602 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7603 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7604 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7605 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7606 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7607
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007608 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7609 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7610
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007611 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7612 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7613 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7614 next servers.
7615
7616 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7617 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7618 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7619
7620 Example :
7621 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7622 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7623 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7624
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007625 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7626 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007627
7628
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007629reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7630reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007631 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7633 no | yes | yes | yes
7634 Arguments :
7635 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7636 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7637 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7638 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7639 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7640 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7641 case.
7642
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007643 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7644 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7645
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007646 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7647 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7648 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7649 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007650 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007651
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007652 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007653 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007654 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007655
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007656 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7657 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7658
7659 Example :
7660 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7661 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7662 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7663
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007664 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7665 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007666
7667
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007668reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7669reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007670 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7672 no | yes | yes | yes
7673 Arguments :
7674 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7675 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7676 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7677 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7678 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7679 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7680 case.
7681
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007682 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7683 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7684
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007685 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7686 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7687 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7688 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7689
7690 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7691 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7692
7693 Example :
7694 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7695 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7696 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7697 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7698
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007699 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7700 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007701
7702
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007703reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7704reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007705 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7707 no | yes | yes | yes
7708 Arguments :
7709 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7710 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7711 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7712 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7713 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7714 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7715
7716 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7717 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7718 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7719 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007720 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007721
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007722 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7723 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7724
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007725 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7726 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7727 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7728
7729 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7730 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7731 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7732 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7733 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7734
7735 Example :
7736 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007737 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007738 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7739 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7740
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007741 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7742 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007743
7744
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007745reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7746reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007747 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7749 no | yes | yes | yes
7750 Arguments :
7751 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7752 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7753 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7754 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7755 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7756 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7757 ignores case.
7758
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007759 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7760 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7761
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007762 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7763 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007764 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7765 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7766 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007767 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7768 not set.
7769
7770 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7771 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7772 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7773 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7774 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7775
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007776 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007777 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007778 # block all others.
7779 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7780 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7781
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007782 # block bad guys
7783 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7784 reqitarpit . if badguys
7785
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007786 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7787 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007788
7789
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007790retries <value>
7791 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7793 yes | no | yes | yes
7794 Arguments :
7795 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7796 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7797 default value is 3.
7798
7799 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7800 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7801 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7802
7803 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007804 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7805 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007806
7807 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7808 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7809
7810 See also : "option redispatch"
7811
7812
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007813rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007814 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7816 no | yes | yes | yes
7817 Arguments :
7818 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7819 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007820 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007821
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007822 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7823 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7824
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007825 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7826 the last header of an HTTP response.
7827
7828 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7829 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7830 responses.
7831
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007832 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7833 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007834
7835
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007836rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7837rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007838 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7840 no | yes | yes | yes
7841 Arguments :
7842 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7843 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7844 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7845 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7846 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7847 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7848 ignores case.
7849
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007850 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7851 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7852
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007853 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7854 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007855 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007856 client.
7857
7858 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7859 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7860 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7861
7862 Example :
7863 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007864 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007865
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007866 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7867 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007868
7869
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007870rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7871rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007872 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7874 no | yes | yes | yes
7875 Arguments :
7876 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7877 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7878 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7879 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7880 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7881 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7882 ignores case.
7883
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007884 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7885 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7886
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007887 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7888 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7889 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7890 case-sensitive.
7891
7892 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007893 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7894 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7895 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007896
7897 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7898 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7899
7900 Example :
7901 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7902 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7903
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007904 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7905 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007906
7907
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007908rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7909rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007910 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7912 no | yes | yes | yes
7913 Arguments :
7914 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7915 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7916 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7917 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7918 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7919 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7920 ignores case.
7921
7922 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7923 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7924 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7925 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007926 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007927
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007928 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7929 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7930
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007931 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7932 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7933 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7934
7935 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7936 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7937 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7938 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7939 are not case-sensitive.
7940
7941 Example :
7942 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7943 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7944
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007945 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7946 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007947
7948
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007949server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007950 Declare a server in a backend
7951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7952 no | no | yes | yes
7953 Arguments :
7954 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007955 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007956 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007957
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007958 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7959 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7960 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7961 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007962 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7963 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7964 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7965 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7966 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007967 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7968 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7969 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7970 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7971 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7972 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7973 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007974 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007975 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7976 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7977 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7978 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7979 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7980 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007981 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7982 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007983 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7984 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007985
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007986 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007987 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7988 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7989 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7990 adding this value to the client's port.
7991
7992 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7993 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007994 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007995
7996 Examples :
7997 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7998 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007999 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008000 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8001 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8002 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008003
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008004 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8005 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8006 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8007 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8008 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8009
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008010 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8011 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008012
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008013server-state-file-name [<file>]
8014 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8015 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8016 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8017 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8018 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8019 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8020
8021 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8022 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8023
8024 global
8025 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8026
8027 backend bk
8028 load-server-state-from-file
8029
8030 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8031 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008032
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008033server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8034 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8035 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8037 no | no | yes | yes
8038
8039 Arguments:
8040 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8041
8042 <num | range>
8043 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8044 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8045 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8046 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8047
8048 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8049
8050 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8051
8052 <params*>
8053 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8054 keyword.
8055
8056 Examples:
8057 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8058 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8059 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8060
8061 # or
8062 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8063
8064 # would be equivalent to:
8065 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8066 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8067 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8068
8069
8070
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008071source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008072source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008073source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008074 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8076 yes | no | yes | yes
8077 Arguments :
8078 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8079 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008080
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008081 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008082 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8083 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8084 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8085 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8086 supported prefixes are :
8087 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8088 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8089 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008090 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008091 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8092 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008093
8094 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8095 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008096 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8097 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8098 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008099
8100 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8101 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8102 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8103 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8104 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8105 <addr>.
8106
8107 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8108 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8109 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8110 port.
8111
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008112 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8113 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8114 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8115 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008116 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008117 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8118 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8119 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8120 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8121 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8122 HTTP header.
8123
8124 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8125 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008126 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008127 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8128 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8129 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8130 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8131 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8132 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8133 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8134
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008135 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8136 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8137 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8138 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8139 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8140 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8141
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008142 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8143 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8144 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8145 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8146
8147 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8148 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8149 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8150 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8151 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8152 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8153
8154 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8155 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8156 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8157 there are two methods :
8158
8159 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8160 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8161 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8162 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8163 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8164 of the client ranges may be used.
8165
8166 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8167 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8168 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8169 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8170 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8171 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8172 same session.
8173
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008174 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8175 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8176 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008177 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008178
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008179 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8180
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008181 Examples :
8182 backend private
8183 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8184 source 192.168.1.200
8185
8186 backend transparent_ssl1
8187 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8188 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8189
8190 backend transparent_ssl2
8191 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8192 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8193 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8194
8195 backend transparent_ssl3
8196 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8197 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8198 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8199
8200 backend transparent_smtp
8201 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8202 # with Tproxy version 4.
8203 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8204
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008205 backend transparent_http
8206 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8207 # proxy.
8208 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008210 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008211 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008213
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008214srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8215 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 yes | no | yes | yes
8218 Arguments :
8219 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8220 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8221 as explained at the top of this document.
8222
8223 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8224 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8225 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8226 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8227 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8228 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8229 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8230
8231 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8232 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8233 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8234 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8235 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008236 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008237 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008238 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008239
8240 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8241 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8242 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8243 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8244 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8245 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8246
8247 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8248 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8249
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008250 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8251 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008252
8253
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008254stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8255 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008257 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008258
8259 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8260 matched.
8261
8262 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8263 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8264
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008265 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8266 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008267 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008268
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008269 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8270 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8271 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8272 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008273
8274 Example :
8275 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8276 backend stats_localhost
8277 stats enable
8278 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8279
8280 Example :
8281 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8282 backend stats_auth
8283 stats enable
8284 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8285 stats admin if TRUE
8286
8287 Example :
8288 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8289 userlist stats-auth
8290 group admin users admin
8291 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8292 group readonly users haproxy
8293 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8294
8295 backend stats_auth
8296 stats enable
8297 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8298 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8299 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8300 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8301
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008302 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8303 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8304 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008305
8306
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008307stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8308 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008310 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008311 Arguments :
8312 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8313
8314 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8315
8316 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8317 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8318 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8319 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8320 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8321 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8322
8323 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8324 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8325 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008326 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008327
8328 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8329 report using "stats scope".
8330
8331 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8332 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8333 unobvious parameters.
8334
8335 Example :
8336 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8337 backend public_www
8338 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8339 stats enable
8340 stats hide-version
8341 stats scope .
8342 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008343 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008344 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8345 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8346
8347 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8348 backend private_monitoring
8349 stats enable
8350 stats uri /admin?stats
8351 stats refresh 5s
8352
8353 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8354
8355
8356stats enable
8357 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008359 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008360 Arguments : none
8361
8362 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8363 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8364 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8365 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8366 - stats auth : no authentication
8367 - stats scope : no restriction
8368
8369 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8370 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8371 unobvious parameters.
8372
8373 Example :
8374 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8375 backend public_www
8376 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8377 stats enable
8378 stats hide-version
8379 stats scope .
8380 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008381 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008382 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8383 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8384
8385 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8386 backend private_monitoring
8387 stats enable
8388 stats uri /admin?stats
8389 stats refresh 5s
8390
8391 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8392
8393
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008394stats hide-version
8395 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008398 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008399
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008400 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8401 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8402 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8403 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8404 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8405 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008407 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8408 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8409 unobvious parameters.
8410
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008411 Example :
8412 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8413 backend public_www
8414 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008415 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008416 stats hide-version
8417 stats scope .
8418 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008419 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008420 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8421 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008422
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008423 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8424 backend private_monitoring
8425 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008426 stats uri /admin?stats
8427 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008429 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008430
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008431
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008432stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8433 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8434 Access control for statistics
8435
8436 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8437 no | no | yes | yes
8438
8439 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8440 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8441 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8442 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8443 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8444 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8445
8446 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8447 instance.
8448
8449 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8450 about ACL usage.
8451
8452
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008453stats realm <realm>
8454 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008456 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008457 Arguments :
8458 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8459 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8460 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8461
8462 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8463 using a backslash ('\').
8464
8465 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8466 only related to authentication.
8467
8468 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8469 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8470 unobvious parameters.
8471
8472 Example :
8473 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8474 backend public_www
8475 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8476 stats enable
8477 stats hide-version
8478 stats scope .
8479 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008480 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008481 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8482 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8483
8484 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8485 backend private_monitoring
8486 stats enable
8487 stats uri /admin?stats
8488 stats refresh 5s
8489
8490 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8491
8492
8493stats refresh <delay>
8494 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008496 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008497 Arguments :
8498 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8499 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8500 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8501 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8502 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8503 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8504
8505 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8506 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8507 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8508 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8509
8510 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8511 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8512 unobvious parameters.
8513
8514 Example :
8515 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8516 backend public_www
8517 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8518 stats enable
8519 stats hide-version
8520 stats scope .
8521 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008522 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008523 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8524 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8525
8526 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8527 backend private_monitoring
8528 stats enable
8529 stats uri /admin?stats
8530 stats refresh 5s
8531
8532 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8533
8534
8535stats scope { <name> | "." }
8536 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008538 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008539 Arguments :
8540 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8541 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8542 section in which the statement appears.
8543
8544 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8545 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8546 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8547 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8548 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8549 exists.
8550
8551 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8552 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8553 unobvious parameters.
8554
8555 Example :
8556 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8557 backend public_www
8558 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8559 stats enable
8560 stats hide-version
8561 stats scope .
8562 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008563 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008564 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8565 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8566
8567 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8568 backend private_monitoring
8569 stats enable
8570 stats uri /admin?stats
8571 stats refresh 5s
8572
8573 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8574
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008575
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008576stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008577 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008579 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008580
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008581 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008582 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8583
8584 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8585 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8586
8587 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8588 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008589 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008590
8591 Example :
8592 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8593 backend private_monitoring
8594 stats enable
8595 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8596 stats uri /admin?stats
8597 stats refresh 5s
8598
8599 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8600 global section.
8601
8602
8603stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008604 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8606 yes | yes | yes | yes
8607 Arguments : none
8608
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008609 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008610 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8611 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8612 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8613 - IP (socket, server)
8614 - cookie (backend, server)
8615
8616 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8617 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008618 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008619
8620 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8621
8622
8623stats show-node [ <name> ]
8624 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008626 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008627 Arguments:
8628 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8629 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8630
8631 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8632 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008633 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008634
8635 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8636 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8637 unobvious parameters.
8638
8639 Example:
8640 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8641 backend private_monitoring
8642 stats enable
8643 stats show-node Europe-1
8644 stats uri /admin?stats
8645 stats refresh 5s
8646
8647 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8648 section.
8649
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008650
8651stats uri <prefix>
8652 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008654 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008655 Arguments :
8656 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8657 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8658 query string.
8659
8660 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8661 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8662 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8663 possible to reach it in the application.
8664
8665 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008666 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008667 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8668 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8669 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8670 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8671
8672 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8673 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8674 an address or a port to statistics only.
8675
8676 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8677 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8678 unobvious parameters.
8679
8680 Example :
8681 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8682 backend public_www
8683 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8684 stats enable
8685 stats hide-version
8686 stats scope .
8687 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008688 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008689 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8690 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8691
8692 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8693 backend private_monitoring
8694 stats enable
8695 stats uri /admin?stats
8696 stats refresh 5s
8697
8698 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8699
8700
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008701stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8702 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008704 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008705
8706 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008707 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008708 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008709 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008710 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8711
8712 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8713 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8714 the "stick-table" statement.
8715
8716 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8717 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8718 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8719 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8720 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8721
8722 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8723 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8724 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8725 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8726 transformation rules.
8727
8728 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8729 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8730 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8731 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8732 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8733 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8734 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8735
8736 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8737 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8738 ACL based conditions.
8739
8740 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8741 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8742 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8743 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8744
8745 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8746 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8747 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8748 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8749
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008750 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8751 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008752 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008753
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008754 Example :
8755 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8756 # last 30 minutes
8757 backend pop
8758 mode tcp
8759 balance roundrobin
8760 stick store-request src
8761 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8762 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8763 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8764
8765 backend smtp
8766 mode tcp
8767 balance roundrobin
8768 stick match src table pop
8769 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8770 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8771
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008772 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008773 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008774
8775
8776stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8777 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8779 no | no | yes | yes
8780
8781 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8782 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8783 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8784 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8785
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008786 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8787 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008788 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008789
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008790 Examples :
8791 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008792 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008793
8794 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8795 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8796 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8797
8798
8799 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8800 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8801 backend http
8802 mode http
8803 balance roundrobin
8804 stick on src table https
8805 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8806 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8807 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8808
8809 backend https
8810 mode tcp
8811 balance roundrobin
8812 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8813 stick on src
8814 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8815 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8816
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008817 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008818
8819
8820stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8821 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 no | no | yes | yes
8824
8825 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008826 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008827 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008828 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008829 server is selected.
8830
8831 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8832 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8833 the "stick-table" statement.
8834
8835 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8836 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8837 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8838 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8839 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8840 address.
8841
8842 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8843 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8844 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8845 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8846 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8847 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8848 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8849 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8850 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8851 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8852
8853 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8854 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8855 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8856 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8857 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8858 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8859 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8860
8861 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8862 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8863 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8864 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8865
8866 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8867 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8868 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8869 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8870 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8871 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008872 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8873 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8874 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8875 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8876 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8877 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008878
8879 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8880 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8881 the request.
8882
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008883 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8884 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008885 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008886
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008887 Example :
8888 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8889 # last 30 minutes
8890 backend pop
8891 mode tcp
8892 balance roundrobin
8893 stick store-request src
8894 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8895 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8896 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8897
8898 backend smtp
8899 mode tcp
8900 balance roundrobin
8901 stick match src table pop
8902 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8903 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8904
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008905 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008906 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008907
8908
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008909stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008910 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8911 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008912 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008914 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008915
8916 Arguments :
8917 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8918 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8919 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8920 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8921
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008922 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8923 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8924 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8925 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8926
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008927 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8928 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8929 instance.
8930
8931 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8932 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8933 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8934 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8935 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8936 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008937 to 32 characters.
8938
8939 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8940 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8941 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008942 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008943 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8944 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008945
8946 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008947 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8948 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008949 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8950 increase.
8951
8952 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008953 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8954 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8955 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008956
8957 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8958 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8959 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8960 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008961 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008962 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8963 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8964 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8965 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8966 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8967 parameter (see below).
8968
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008969 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8970 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8971 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8972 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8973 soft restart.
8974
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008975 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8976 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008977
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008978 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8979 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8980 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8981 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008982 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008983 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008984 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8985 if not expiration delay is specified.
8986
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008987 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8988 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8989 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8990 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008991 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8992 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8993 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8994 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8995 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8996 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8997 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8998 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8999 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9000 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9001 types and their arguments.
9002
9003 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9004 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9005 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9006 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9007
9008 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9009 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9010 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009011 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009012
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009013 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9014 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9015 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009016 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009017 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009018 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009019
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009020 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9021 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9022 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9023 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9024
9025 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9026 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9027 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9028 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9029 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9030 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9031
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009032 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9033 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9034 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9035 they were received.
9036
9037 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9038 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9039 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9040 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9041 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9042
9043 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9044 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9045 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9046 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9047 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9048
9049 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9050 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9051 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9052
9053 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9054 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9055 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9056 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9057 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9058
9059 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9060 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9061 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9062 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9063 the client side.
9064
9065 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9066 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9067 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9068 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9069 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9070 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9071 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9072
9073 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9074 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9075 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9076 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9077 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9078 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009079 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009080
9081 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9082 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9083 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9084 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9085 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9086 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9087
9088 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009089 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009090 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9091 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9092
9093 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9094 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9095 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9096 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9097 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9098 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9099 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9100 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9101 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9102 recommended for better fairness.
9103
9104 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009105 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009106 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9107 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9108
9109 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9110 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9111 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9112 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9113 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9114 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9115 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9116 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9117 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9118 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009119
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009120 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9121 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009122 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9123 reference it.
9124
9125 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9126 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009127 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9128 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9129 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009130
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009131 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9132 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9133 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9134 something that can be ignored.
9135
9136 Example:
9137 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9138 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9139 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9140 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9141
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009142 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009143 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009144
9145
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009146stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009147 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9149 no | no | yes | yes
9150
9151 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009152 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009153 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009154 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009155 server is selected.
9156
9157 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9158 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9159 the "stick-table" statement.
9160
9161 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9162 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9163 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9164 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9165
9166 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9167 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9168 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9169 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9170 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9171 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009172 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009173 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9174 rules.
9175
9176 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9177 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9178 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9179 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9180 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9181 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9182 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9183
9184 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9185 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9186 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9187 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9188
9189 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9190 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9191 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9192 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9193 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9194 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009195 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9196 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9197 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9198 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9199 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9200 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9201 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9202 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9203 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009204
9205 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9206
9207 Example :
9208 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9209 backend https
9210 mode tcp
9211 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009212 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009213 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009214
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009215 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9216 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9217
9218 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9219 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9220 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9221
9222 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9223 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009224
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009225 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9226 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9227 # at offset 44.
9228
9229 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9230 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9231
9232 # Learn on response if server hello.
9233 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009234
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009235 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9236 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9237
9238 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9239 extraction.
9240
9241
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009242tcp-check connect [params*]
9243 Opens a new connection
9244 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9245 no | no | yes | yes
9246
9247 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9248 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9249 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9250
9251 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9252 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9253 of the sequence.
9254
9255 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9256 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9257 do.
9258
9259 Parameters :
9260 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9261 use the TCP connection.
9262
9263 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9264 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9265 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9266
9267 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9268
9269 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9270
9271 Examples:
9272 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9273 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9274 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9275 option tcp-check
9276 tcp-check connect
9277 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9278 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9279 tcp-check send \r\n
9280 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9281 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9282 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9283 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9284 tcp-check send \r\n
9285 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9286 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9287
9288 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9289 option tcp-check
9290 tcp-check connect port 110
9291 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9292 tcp-check connect port 143
9293 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9294 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9295
9296 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9297
9298
9299tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009300 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009301 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9302 no | no | yes | yes
9303
9304 Arguments :
9305 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9306 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9307 binary.
9308 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9309 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9310 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9311
9312 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9313 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9314 with the usual backslash ('\').
9315 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009316 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009317 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9318 used upper or lower case.
9319
9320
9321 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9322
9323 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9324 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9325 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9326 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9327 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9328 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9329 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9330 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9331
9332 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9333 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9334 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9335 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9336 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9337 expression.
9338
9339 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9340 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9341 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9342 this exact hexadecimal string.
9343 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9344
9345 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9346 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9347 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9348 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9349 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9350 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9351 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9352 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9353 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9354 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9355 the null character.
9356
9357 Examples :
9358 # perform a POP check
9359 option tcp-check
9360 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9361
9362 # perform an IMAP check
9363 option tcp-check
9364 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9365
9366 # look for the redis master server
9367 option tcp-check
9368 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009369 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009370 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9371 tcp-check expect string role:master
9372 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9373 tcp-check expect string +OK
9374
9375
9376 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9377 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9378
9379
9380tcp-check send <data>
9381 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9382 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9383 no | no | yes | yes
9384
9385 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9386 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9387
9388 Examples :
9389 # look for the redis master server
9390 option tcp-check
9391 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9392 tcp-check expect string role:master
9393
9394 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9395 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9396
9397
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009398tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9399 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009400 tcp health check
9401 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9402 no | no | yes | yes
9403
9404 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9405 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009406 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009407 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9408 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9409 hexadecimal string.
9410 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9411
9412 Examples :
9413 # redis check in binary
9414 option tcp-check
9415 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9416 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9417
9418
9419 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9420 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9421
9422
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009423tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9424 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9426 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009427 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009428 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9429 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009430
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009431 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009432
9433 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9434 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009435 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9436 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9437 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9438 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9439 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9440 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009441
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009442 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9443 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9444 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9445 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009446
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009447 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009448 - accept :
9449 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9450 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9451 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009452
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009453 - reject :
9454 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9455 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9456 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9457 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9458 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9459 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9460 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9461 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9462 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9463 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9464 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009465 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009466
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009467 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9468 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9469 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9470 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9471 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9472 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9473 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9474 hosts.
9475
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009476 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9477 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9478 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9479 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9480 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9481 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9482 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9483 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9484
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009485 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9486 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9487 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9488 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9489 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9490 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9491 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9492 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9493 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009494 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9495 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009496
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009497 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009498 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009499 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9500 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9501 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9502 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9503 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9504 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9505 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9506 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9507 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9508 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9509 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9510 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009512 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009513 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009514 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009515 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009516 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9517 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9518 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009520 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9521 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9522 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9523 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009525 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9526 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9527 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9528 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9529 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009530 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9531 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9532 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9533 layer7 information is extracted.
9534
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009535 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9536 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9537 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9538 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9539 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009540
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009541 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9542 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9543 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9544 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9545
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009546 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9547 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9548 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9549 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9550
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009551 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9552 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9553 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9554 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9555 continues.
9556
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009557 - set-src <expr> :
9558 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9559 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9560 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009561 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009562
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009563 Arguments:
9564 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9565 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009566
9567 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009568 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9569
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009570 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9571 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009572
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009573 - set-src-port <expr> :
9574 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9575 expression.
9576
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009577 Arguments:
9578 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9579 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009580
9581 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009582 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9583
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009584 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9585 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9586 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009587
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009588 - set-dst <expr> :
9589 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9590 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9591 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9592 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9593 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9594
9595 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9596 followed by some converters.
9597
9598 Example:
9599
9600 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9601 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9602
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009603 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9604 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9605
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009606 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9607 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9608 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9609 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9610
9611
9612 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9613 followed by some converters.
9614
9615 Example:
9616
9617 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9618
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009619 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9620 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9621 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9622
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009623 - "silent-drop" :
9624 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009625 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009626 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9627 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9628 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9629 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9630 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9632 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009633 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9634 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009635 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009636 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9637 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9638 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9639 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9640
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009641 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9642 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9643 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009644
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009645 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9646 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9647 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009648
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009649 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009650 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009651 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009652
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009653 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9654 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9655 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009656
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009657 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009658 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9659 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009660
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009661 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9662
9663 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9664
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009665 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9666
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009667 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009668
9669
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009670tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9671 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009673 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009674 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009675 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9676 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009677
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009678 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009679
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009680 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009681 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9682 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9683 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9684 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009685
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009686 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9687 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9688 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9689 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009690 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9691 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9692 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9693 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9694 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9695 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009696 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009697 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009698
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009699 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9700 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9701 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9702 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009703
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009704 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009705 - accept : the request is accepted
9706 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9707 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009708 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009709 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009710 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009711 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009712 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009713 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009714 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009715 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009716 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009717
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009718 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9719 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009720
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009721 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9722 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9723 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9724 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9725 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9726 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009728 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009729 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9730 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009732 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009733 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9734 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9735 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9736 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009737 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9738 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9739 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009740
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009741 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009742 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9743 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9744 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009745
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009746 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009747 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9748 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009749
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009750 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9751 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009752 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009753 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9754 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009755 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009756 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009757 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009758 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9759 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009760 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009761 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9762 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009763
9764 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9765 followed by some converters.
9766
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009767 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9768 <var-name>.
9769
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009770 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9771 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9772 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9773 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9774 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9775
9776 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9777 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9778 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9779 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9780 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9781 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9782 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9783 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9784 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9785 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9786 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9787
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009788 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9789 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9790 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9791 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9792 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9793
9794 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9795
9796 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9797
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009798 Example:
9799
9800 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009801 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009802
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009803 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009804 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9805 # and reject everything else.
9806 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9807 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009808 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009809 tcp-request content reject
9810
9811 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009812 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9813 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9814 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009815 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009816
9817 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9818 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9819 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009820 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009821 tcp-request content reject
9822
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009823 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009824 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009825 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009826 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009827 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9828 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009829
9830 Example:
9831 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9832 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009833 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009834
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009835 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009836 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009837
9838 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009839 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009840 # protecting all our sites
9841 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009842 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9843 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009844 ...
9845 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9846
9847 backend http_dynamic
9848 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009849 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009850 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009851 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009852 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009853 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009854 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009856 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009857
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009858 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9859 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009860
9861
9862tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9863 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009865 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009866 Arguments :
9867 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9868 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9869 as explained at the top of this document.
9870
9871 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9872 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9873 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9874 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9875 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9876
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009877 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9878 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9879 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9880 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9881
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009882 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9883 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009884 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009885 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009886 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9887 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9888 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9889 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009890
9891 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9892 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9893 it pass through unaffected.
9894
9895 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9896 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9897 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009898 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009899 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9900 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009901 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9902 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9903 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009904
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009905 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009906 "timeout client".
9907
9908
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009909tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9910 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9912 no | no | yes | yes
9913 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009914 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9915 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009916
9917 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9918
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009919 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009920 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9921 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009922 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9923 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009924
9925 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9926
9927 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9928 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9929 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9930 inserted.
9931
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009932 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009933 - accept :
9934 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9935 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9936 the rules evaluation.
9937
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009938 - close :
9939 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9940 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9941 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9942 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9943 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9944 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009945 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009946 protocols.
9947
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009948 - reject :
9949 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9950 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009951 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009952
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009953 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9954 Sets a variable.
9955
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009956 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9957 Unsets a variable.
9958
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009959 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9960 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9961 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9962 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9963
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009964 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9965 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9966 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9967 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9968
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009969 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9970 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9971 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9972 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9973 continues.
9974
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009975 - "silent-drop" :
9976 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009977 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009978 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9979 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9980 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9981 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9982 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009983 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9984 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009985 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9986 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009987 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009988 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9989 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9990 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9991 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9992
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009993 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9994 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9995
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009996 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9997 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9998 for changing the default action to a reject.
9999
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010000 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10001 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10002 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10003 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010004 period.
10005
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010006 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10007 declared inline.
10008
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010009 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10010 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010011 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010012 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10013 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010014 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010015 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010016 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010017 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10018 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010019 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010020 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10021 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010022
10023 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10024 followed by some converters.
10025
10026 Example:
10027
10028 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10029
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010030 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10031 <var-name>.
10032
10033 Example:
10034
10035 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10036
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010037 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10038 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10039 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10040 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10041 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10042
10043 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10044
10045 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10046
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010047 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10048
10049 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10050
10051
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010052tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10053 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10055 no | yes | yes | no
10056 Arguments :
10057 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10058 below.
10059
10060 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10061
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010062 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010063 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10064 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10065 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10066 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10067 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10068 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10069 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010070 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010071 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10072 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10073 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10074 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10075 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10076 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10077 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10078 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10079 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10080 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10081 instead.
10082
10083 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10084 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10085 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10086 rules which may be inserted.
10087
10088 Several types of actions are supported :
10089 - accept : the request is accepted
10090 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10091 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10092 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010093 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010094 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10095 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010096 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010097 - silent-drop
10098
10099 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10100 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10101 sections for a complete description.
10102
10103 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10104 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10105 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10106
10107 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10108 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10109 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10110 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10111 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10112
10113 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10114 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10115
10116 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10117 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10118 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10119
10120 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10121 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10122 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10123
10124 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10125 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10126 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10127
10128 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10129 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10130 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10131
10132 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10133
10134 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10135
10136
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010137tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10138 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10140 no | no | yes | yes
10141 Arguments :
10142 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10143 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10144 as explained at the top of this document.
10145
10146 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10147
10148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010149timeout check <timeout>
10150 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10151 established.
10152
10153 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10154 yes | no | yes | yes
10155 Arguments:
10156 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10157 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10158 as explained at the top of this document.
10159
10160 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10161 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010162 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010163 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010164 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10165 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10166 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010167
10168 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10169 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10170
10171 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10172 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010173 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010174
10175 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10176 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10177 forget about it.
10178
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010179 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10180 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010181
10182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010183timeout client <timeout>
10184timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10185 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10187 yes | yes | yes | no
10188 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010189 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010190 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10191 as explained at the top of this document.
10192
10193 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10194 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10195 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010196 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10197 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10198 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10199 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010200 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10201 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10202 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010203 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010204 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010205 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10206 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010207 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10208 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010209
10210 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10211 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10212 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10213 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10214 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10215 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10216
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010217 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010219 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10220 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10221 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10222
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010223 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10224 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010225
10226
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010227timeout client-fin <timeout>
10228 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10230 yes | yes | yes | no
10231 Arguments :
10232 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10233 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10234 as explained at the top of this document.
10235
10236 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10237 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10238 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10239 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10240 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10241 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10242 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010243 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10244 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10245 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010246
10247 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10248 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10249 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10250
10251 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10252
10253
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010254timeout connect <timeout>
10255timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10256 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10258 yes | no | yes | yes
10259 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010260 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010261 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10262 as explained at the top of this document.
10263
10264 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010265 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010266 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010267 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010268 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10269 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010270
10271 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10272 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10273 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10274 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10275 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10276 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10277
10278 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10279 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10280 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10281
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010282 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10283 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010284
10285
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010286timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10287 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10289 yes | yes | yes | yes
10290 Arguments :
10291 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10292 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10293 as explained at the top of this document.
10294
10295 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10296 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10297 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10298 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10299 once the request has started to present itself.
10300
10301 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10302 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10303 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10304 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10305 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10306
10307 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10308 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10309 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10310 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10311
10312 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10313 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010314 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010315 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10316 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010317 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010318
10319 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10320 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10321 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10322 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10323
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010324 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10325 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010326 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10327
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010328 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10329
10330
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010331timeout http-request <timeout>
10332 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010334 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010335 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010336 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010337 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10338 as explained at the top of this document.
10339
10340 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10341 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10342 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10343 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10344 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10345 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10346 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010347 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10348 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10349 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10350 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010351 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010352 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10353 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010354
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010355 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10356 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10357 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10358 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10359 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010360 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010361
10362 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10363 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010364 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010365 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10366 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10367
10368 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010369 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10370 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10371 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010372
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010373 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010374 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010375
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010376
10377timeout queue <timeout>
10378 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10380 yes | no | yes | yes
10381 Arguments :
10382 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10384 as explained at the top of this document.
10385
10386 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10387 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10388 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10389 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10390 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10391
10392 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10393 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10394 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10395 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10396
10397 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10398
10399
10400timeout server <timeout>
10401timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10402 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10404 yes | no | yes | yes
10405 Arguments :
10406 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10407 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10408 as explained at the top of this document.
10409
10410 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10411 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10412 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10413 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10414 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10415 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10416 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10417
10418 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10419 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10420 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10421 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10422 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010423 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010424 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010425 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10426 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010427 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10428 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010429
10430 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10431 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10432 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10433 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10434 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10435 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10436
10437 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10438 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10439 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10440
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010441 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010442
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010443
10444timeout server-fin <timeout>
10445 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10447 yes | no | yes | yes
10448 Arguments :
10449 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10450 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10451 as explained at the top of this document.
10452
10453 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10454 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10455 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10456 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10457 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10458 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10459 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10460 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10461 situations, it should not be needed.
10462
10463 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10464 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10465 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10466
10467 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10468
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010469
10470timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010471 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10473 yes | yes | yes | yes
10474 Arguments :
10475 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10476 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10477 as explained at the top of this document.
10478
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010479 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10480 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10481 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10482 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010483
10484 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10485 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10486 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10487 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010488 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010489
10490 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10491
10492
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010493timeout tunnel <timeout>
10494 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10496 yes | no | yes | yes
10497 Arguments :
10498 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10499 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10500 as explained at the top of this document.
10501
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010502 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010503 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10504 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10505 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010506 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10507 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010508 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10509 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10510 specified.
10511
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010512 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10513 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10514 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10515 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10516 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10517 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10518 state.
10519
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010520 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10521 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10522 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10523 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010524 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010525
10526 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10527 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10528 forget about it.
10529
10530 Example :
10531 defaults http
10532 option http-server-close
10533 timeout connect 5s
10534 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010535 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010536 timeout server 30s
10537 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10538
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010539 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010540
10541
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010542transparent (deprecated)
10543 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010545 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010546 Arguments : none
10547
10548 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10549 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10550 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10551 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10552 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10553 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10554 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10555 appropriate server.
10556
10557 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10558
10559 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10560 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10561
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010562 See also: "option transparent"
10563
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010564unique-id-format <string>
10565 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10567 yes | yes | yes | no
10568 Arguments :
10569 <string> is a log-format string.
10570
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010571 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10572 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10573 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10574 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010575
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010576 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10577 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10578 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10579 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10580 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10581 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10582 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10583 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010584
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010585 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10586 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010587
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010588 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010589
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010590 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010591
10592 will generate:
10593
10594 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10595
10596 See also: "unique-id-header"
10597
10598unique-id-header <name>
10599 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10601 yes | yes | yes | no
10602 Arguments :
10603 <name> is the name of the header.
10604
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010605 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10606 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010607
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010608 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010609
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010610 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010611 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10612
10613 will generate:
10614
10615 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10616
10617 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010618
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010619use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010620 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10622 no | yes | yes | no
10623 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010624 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10625 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010626
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010627 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10628 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010629
10630 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10631 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10632 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010633 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010634 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010635 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10636 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010637
10638 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10639 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10640 assign the backend.
10641
10642 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10643 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10644 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10645 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10646 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10647 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10648
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010649 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010650 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010651 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10652 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10653 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10654
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010655 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10656 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10657 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10658 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10659 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10660 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10661 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10662 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10663 cannot be forced from the request.
10664
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010665 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010666 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10667 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10668
10669 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10670 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010671
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010672
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010673use-server <server> if <condition>
10674use-server <server> unless <condition>
10675 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10677 no | no | yes | yes
10678 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010679 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010680
10681 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10682
10683 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10684 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10685 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10686
10687 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10688 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10689 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10690 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10691 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10692 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10693 matches will assign the server.
10694
10695 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10696 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10697 with the next rules until one matches.
10698
10699 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10700 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10701 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10702 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10703
10704 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10705 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10706 stripped.
10707
10708 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10709 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10710 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10711 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10712
10713 Example :
10714 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10715 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10716 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10717 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10718 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10719 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010720 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010721 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10722 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10723
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010724 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010725
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010726
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107275. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010728--------------------------
10729
10730The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10731depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10732settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10733written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10734described in this section.
10735
10736
107375.1. Bind options
10738-----------------
10739
10740The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10741as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10742no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10743parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10744while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10745provided immediately after the setting name.
10746
10747The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10748
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010749accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10750 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10751 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10752 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10753 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10754 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10755 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10756 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10757 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10758 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010759 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10760 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10761 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010762
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010763accept-proxy
10764 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010765 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10766 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010767 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10768 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10769 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10770 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010771 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010772 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10773 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010774 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10775 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010776
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010777allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010778 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010779 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10780 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10781 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10782 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010783
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010784alpn <protocols>
10785 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10786 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10787 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10788 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10789 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010790 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10791 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10792 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10793 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10794 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10795 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10796 preference, like below :
10797
10798 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010799
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010800backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010801 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010802 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10803
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010804curves <curves>
10805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10806 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10807 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10808 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10809 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10810 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10811
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010812ecdhe <named curve>
10813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010814 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10815 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010816
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010817ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10819 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10820 client's certificate.
10821
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010822ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10824 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10825 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10826 error is ignored.
10827
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010828ca-sign-file <cafile>
10829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10830 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10831 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10832 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10833 'generate-certificates' for details.
10834
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010835ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10837 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10838 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10839 'generate-certificates' for details.
10840
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010841ciphers <ciphers>
10842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10843 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010844 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010845 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010846 information and recommendations see e.g.
10847 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10848 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10849 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10850
10851ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10853 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10854 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10855 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010856 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10857 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010858
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010859crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10861 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10862 to verify client's certificate.
10863
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010864crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10866 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10867 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10868 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10869 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10870 file.
10871
10872 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10873 are loaded.
10874
10875 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010876 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010877 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10878 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10879 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10880 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010881 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10882 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010883 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010884
10885 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10886 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10887 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10888 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010889 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10890 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010891
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010892 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010893
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010894 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010895 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010896 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10897 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010898 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10899 clients).
10900
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010901 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10902 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10903 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10904 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10905 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10906 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10907 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10908 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10909 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10910 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10911 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10912 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10913 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10914
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010915 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10916 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10917 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10918 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10919 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10920
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010921 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10922 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10923 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10924 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010925
10926 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10927 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10928 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10929 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10930 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10931 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10932 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10933 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10934 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10935
10936 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10937
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010938 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010939 a cert bundle.
10940
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010941 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010942 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10943 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10944 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10945 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10946 provide multi-cert support.
10947
10948 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10949
10950 Filename | CN | SAN
10951 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10952 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010953 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010954 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10955 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10956
10957 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10958 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10959 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10960 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010961 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10962 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10963 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010964
10965 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10966 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10967
10968 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10969 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10970 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10971
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010972crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010973 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010974 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010975 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010976 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010977
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010978crt-list <file>
10979 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010980 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10981 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010982
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010983 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10984
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010985 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10986 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010987 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010988 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010989
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010990 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10991 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10992 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10993 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10994 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10995 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10996 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10997 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010998
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010999 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011000 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011001 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11002 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11003 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011004
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011005 crt-list file example:
11006 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011007 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011008 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011009 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011010
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011011defer-accept
11012 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11013 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11014 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011015 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011016 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11017 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11018 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11019 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11020 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11021 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11022 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11023
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011024expose-fd listeners
11025 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11026 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011027 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11028 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011030
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011031force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011032 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011033 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011034 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011035 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011036
11037force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011038 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011039 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011040 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011041
11042force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011043 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011044 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011045 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011046
11047force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011048 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011049 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011050 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011051
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011052force-tlsv13
11053 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11054 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011055 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011056
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011057generate-certificates
11058 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11059 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11060 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11061 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11062 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11063 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11064 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11065 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11066 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11067 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11068 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11069
11070 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11071 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011072 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011073 certificate is used many times.
11074
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011075gid <gid>
11076 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11077 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11078 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11079 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11080 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11081
11082group <group>
11083 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11084 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11085 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11086 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11087 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11088
11089id <id>
11090 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11091 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11092 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11093 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11094
11095interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011096 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11097 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11098 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11099 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11100 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11101 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011102 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11103 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11104 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11105 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11106 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11107 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011108
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011109level <level>
11110 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11111 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11112 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011113 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011114 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11115 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11116 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011117 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011118 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011119 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011120 all counters).
11121
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011122severity-output <format>
11123 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11124 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11125 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11126 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11127 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11128 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11129 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11130 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11131 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11132 rfc5424 convention.
11133
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011134maxconn <maxconn>
11135 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11136 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11137 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11138 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11139 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11140 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11141 eat all memory.
11142
11143mode <mode>
11144 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11145 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11146 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11147 UNIX sockets.
11148
11149mss <maxseg>
11150 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11151 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11152 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11153 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11154 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11155 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11156 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11157 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11158 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11159 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11160 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11161
11162name <name>
11163 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11164 page.
11165
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011166namespace <name>
11167 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11168 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11169 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11170 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11171
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011172nice <nice>
11173 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11174 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11175 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11176 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11177 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11178 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11179 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11180 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11181 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11182 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11183 one for an RDP socket.
11184
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011185no-ca-names
11186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11187 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11188
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011189no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011190 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011191 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011192 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011193 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011194 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11195 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011196
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011197no-tls-tickets
11198 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11199 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11200 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011201 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11202 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011203
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011204no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011205 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011206 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011207 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011208 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011209 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11210 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011211
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011212no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011213 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011214 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011215 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011216 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011217 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11218 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011219
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011220no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011222 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011223 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011224 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011225 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11226 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011227
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011228no-tlsv13
11229 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11230 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11231 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11232 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011233 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11234 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011235
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011236npn <protocols>
11237 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11238 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11239 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11240 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011241 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011242 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11243 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11244 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11245 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11246 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011247
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011248prefer-client-ciphers
11249 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11250 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11251 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011252 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11253 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11254 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011255
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011256process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011257 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011258 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011259 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011260 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11261 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11262 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11263 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011264 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011265 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11266 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11267 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11268 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11269 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011270
11271 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11272
11273 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11274 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11275 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11276 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11277 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11278 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11279 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11280 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011281
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011282proto <name>
11283 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11284 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11285 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11286 in haproxy -vv.
11287 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11288 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011289 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011290 h2" on the bind line.
11291
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011292ssl
11293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011294 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011295 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11296 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011297 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11298 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011299
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011300ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11301 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11302 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11303 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11304
11305ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11306 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11307 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11308 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11309
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011310strict-sni
11311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11312 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11313 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11314 See the "crt" option for more information.
11315
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011316tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011317 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011318 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11319 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011320 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011321 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11322 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11323 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11324 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11325 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11326 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11327 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11328
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011329tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011330 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011331 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11332 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11333 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11334 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11335 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11336 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11337 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011338 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11339 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11340 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011341
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011342tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11343 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011344 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11345 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11346 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11347 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11348 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11349 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11350 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11351 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11352 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11353 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011354 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11355 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11356
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011357transparent
11358 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11359 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11360 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11361 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11362 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11363 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11364 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11365 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11366 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11367 so check for support with your vendor.
11368
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011369v4v6
11370 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11371 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11372 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11373 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011374 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011375
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011376v6only
11377 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11378 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11379 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011380 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11381 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011382
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011383uid <uid>
11384 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11385 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11386 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11387 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11388 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11389
11390user <user>
11391 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11392 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11393 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11394 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11395 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11396
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011397verify [none|optional|required]
11398 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11399 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11400 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11401 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11402 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011403 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11404 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11405 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11406 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011407
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114085.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011409------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011411The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11412which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11413arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11414settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11415after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11416Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11417address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011419 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011420 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011421
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011422Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11423keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011425The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011426
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011427addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011428 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011429 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11430 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11431 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11432 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11433 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011434
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011435agent-check
11436 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011437 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011438 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11439 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11440 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011441
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011442 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011443 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011444 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11445 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11446 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011447
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011448 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11449 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11450 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11451 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11452 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011453
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011454 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011455 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011456
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011457 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11458 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11459 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011460
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011461 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11462 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11463 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011464
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011465 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11466 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11467 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11468 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11469 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011470 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011471 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011472
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011473 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11474 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011475
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011476 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11477 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11478 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11479 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11480 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11481 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11482 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11483 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11484 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011485
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011486 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11487 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011488 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11489 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11490 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011491 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011492
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011493 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011494 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011495
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011496agent-send <string>
11497 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11498 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11499 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11500 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11501 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11502
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011503agent-inter <delay>
11504 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11505 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11506
11507 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11508 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11509 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11510 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11511 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11512 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11513 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11514 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11515 of backends use the same servers.
11516
11517 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11518
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011519agent-addr <addr>
11520 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11521
11522 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11523 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11524 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11525 hostname, it will be resolved.
11526
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011527agent-port <port>
11528 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11529
11530 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11531
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011532alpn <protocols>
11533 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11534 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11535 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11536 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11537 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11538 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11539 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11540 now obsolete NPN extension.
11541 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11542 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11543
11544 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011546backup
11547 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11548 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11549 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11550 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011551 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11552 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011553
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011554ca-file <cafile>
11555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11556 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11557 server's certificate.
11558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011559check
11560 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011561 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11562 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11563 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11564 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11565 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11566 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11567 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011568 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11569 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011570 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11571 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011572
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011573check-send-proxy
11574 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11575 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11576 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11577 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11578 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11579 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11580 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11581
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011582check-alpn <protocols>
11583 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11584 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11585 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11586
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011587check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011588 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011589 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11590 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011591
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011592check-ssl
11593 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11594 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11595 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11596 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011597 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011598 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11599 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011600 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011601 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11602 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011603
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011604ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11606 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11607 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011608 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11609 information and recommendations see e.g.
11610 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11611 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11612 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011613
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011614ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11616 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11617 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11618 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011619 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11620 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11621 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011623cookie <value>
11624 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11625 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11626 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11627 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11628 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11629 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11630 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11631
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011632crl-file <crlfile>
11633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11634 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11635 to verify server's certificate.
11636
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011637crt <cert>
11638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11639 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11640 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11641 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11642 certificate request.
11643
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011644disabled
11645 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11646 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11647 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11648 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11649 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011650 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011651
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011652enabled
11653 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11654 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11655 default value.
11656 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11657 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011659error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011660 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11661 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11662 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011664 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011666fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011667 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11668 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11669 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11670
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011671force-sslv3
11672 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11673 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011674 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011675 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011676
11677force-tlsv10
11678 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011679 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011680 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011681
11682force-tlsv11
11683 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011684 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011685 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011686
11687force-tlsv12
11688 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011689 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011690 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011691
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011692force-tlsv13
11693 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11694 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011695 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011697id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011698 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11699 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11700 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011701
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011702init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11703 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11704 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011705 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011706 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11707 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11708 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11709 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11710 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11711 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11712 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11713 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11714 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011715 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011716 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11717 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11718 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11719 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11720 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11721 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011722 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011723
11724 Example:
11725 defaults
11726 # never fail on address resolution
11727 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11728
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011729inter <delay>
11730fastinter <delay>
11731downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011732 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11733 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11734 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11735 between checks depending on the server state :
11736
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011737 Server state | Interval used
11738 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11739 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11740 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11741 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11742 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11743 or yet unchecked. |
11744 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11745 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11746 | "inter" otherwise.
11747 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011749 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11750 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11751 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11752 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011753 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11754 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11755 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11756 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11757 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011759maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011760 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11761 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11762 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11763 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11764 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11765 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11766 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11767 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011769maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011770 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11771 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11772 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11773 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11774 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11775 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11776 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11777
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011778max-reuse <count>
11779 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11780 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11781 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11782 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11783 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11784 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11785 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11786 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011788minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011789 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11790 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11791 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11792 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11793 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11794 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011795 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011796 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011797
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011798namespace <name>
11799 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11800 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11801 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11802 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11803
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011804no-agent-check
11805 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11806 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11807 default value.
11808 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11809 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11810
11811no-backup
11812 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11813 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11814 default value.
11815 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11816 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11817
11818no-check
11819 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11820 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11821 default value.
11822 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11823 "default-server" "check" setting.
11824
11825no-check-ssl
11826 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11827 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11828 default value.
11829 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11830 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11831
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011832no-send-proxy
11833 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11834 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11835 default value.
11836 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11837 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11838
11839no-send-proxy-v2
11840 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11841 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11842 default value.
11843 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11844 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11845
11846no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11847 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11848 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11849 default value.
11850 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11851 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11852
11853no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11854 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11855 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11856 default value.
11857 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11858 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11859
11860no-ssl
11861 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11862 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11863 default value.
11864 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11865 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11866
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011867no-ssl-reuse
11868 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11869 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11870 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11871 and for paranoid users.
11872
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011873no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011874 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11875 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011876 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011877
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011878 Supported in default-server: No
11879
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011880no-tls-tickets
11881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11882 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11883 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011884 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11885 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011886 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011887
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011888no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011889 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011890 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11891 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011892 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11893 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011894 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011895
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011896 Supported in default-server: No
11897
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011898no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011899 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011900 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11901 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011902 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11903 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011904 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011905
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011906 Supported in default-server: No
11907
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011908no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011909 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011910 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11911 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011912 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11913 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011914 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011915
11916 Supported in default-server: No
11917
11918no-tlsv13
11919 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11920 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11921 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11922 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11923 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011924 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011925
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011926 Supported in default-server: No
11927
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011928no-verifyhost
11929 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11930 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11931 default value.
11932 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11933 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011934
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011935non-stick
11936 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11937 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11938 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11939
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011940npn <protocols>
11941 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11942 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11943 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11944 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11945 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11946 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11947 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011949observe <mode>
11950 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11951 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11952 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11953 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11954 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11955 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011956 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011957
11958 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011960on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011961 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11962 Currently, four modes are available:
11963 - fastinter: force fastinter
11964 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11965 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11966 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11967 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11968
11969 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11970
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011971on-marked-down <action>
11972 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11973 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011974 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11975 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11976 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11977 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11978 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11979 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11980 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11981 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011982
11983 Actions are disabled by default
11984
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011985on-marked-up <action>
11986 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11987 Currently one action is available:
11988 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11989 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11990 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11991 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011992 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11993 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011994 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11995 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11996
11997 Actions are disabled by default
11998
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011999pool-max-conn <max>
12000 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12001 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12002 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12003 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12004 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12005 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12006
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012007pool-purge-delay <delay>
12008 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012009 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12010 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012012port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012013 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12014 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12015 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12016 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12017 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12018 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12019
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012020proto <name>
12021
12022 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12023 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12024 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12025 reported in haproxy -vv.
12026 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12027 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012029redir <prefix>
12030 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12031 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12032 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12033 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12034 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12035 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12036 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12037 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012038 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012039 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012040 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12041 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12042 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12043 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12044
12045 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012047rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012048 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12049 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12050 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12051
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012052resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12053 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12054 server.
12055
12056 Available options:
12057
12058 * allow-dup-ip
12059 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12060 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12061 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12062 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12063 For such case, simply enable this option.
12064 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12065
12066 * prevent-dup-ip
12067 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12068 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12069 same fqdn.
12070 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12071
12072 Example:
12073 backend b_myapp
12074 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12075 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12076 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12077
12078 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12079 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12080 it
12081 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12082 different address
12083
12084 Default value: not set
12085
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012086resolve-prefer <family>
12087 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12088 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12089 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12090 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12091
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012092 Default value: ipv6
12093
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012094 Example:
12095
12096 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012097
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012098resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12099 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12100 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012101 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012102 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12103 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012104 configured network, another address is selected.
12105
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012106 Example:
12107
12108 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012109
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012110resolvers <id>
12111 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12112 hostname.
12113
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012114 Example:
12115
12116 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012117
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012118 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012119
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012120send-proxy
12121 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12122 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12123 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12124 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012125 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12126 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12127 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12128 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12129 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12130 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12131 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12132 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12133 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12134 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012135 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12136 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012137
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012138send-proxy-v2
12139 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12140 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12141 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12142 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012143 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12144 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12145 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12146 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012147
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012148proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12149 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12150 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012151 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12152 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012153 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12154 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012155 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012156
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012157send-proxy-v2-ssl
12158 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12159 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12160 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12161 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12162 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12163 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12164 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012165 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12166 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012167
12168send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12169 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12170 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12171 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12172 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12173 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12174 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12175 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12176 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012177 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12178 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012179
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012180slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012181 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12182 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12183 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12184 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12185 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12186 parameters :
12187
12188 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12189 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12190
12191 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12192 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12193 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12194 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12195
12196 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12197 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12198 seen as failed.
12199
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012200sni <expression>
12201 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12202 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12203 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12204 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012205 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12206 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012207 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012208 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12209 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012210
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012211source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012212source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012213source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012214 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12215 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12216 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12217 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12218
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012219 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12220 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12221 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12222 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12223 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12224 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12225 server.
12226
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012227 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12228 specifying the source address without port(s).
12229
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012230ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012231 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12232 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12233 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12234 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12235 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12236 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012237 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12238 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012239
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012240ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12241 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12242 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12243 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12244
12245ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12246 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12247 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12248 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12249
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012250ssl-reuse
12251 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12252 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12253 default value.
12254 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12255 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12256
12257stick
12258 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12259 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12260 default value.
12261 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12262 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012263
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012264tcp-ut <delay>
12265 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12266 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12267 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012268 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012269 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12270 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12271 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12272 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12273 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12274 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12275 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12276 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12277 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012279track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012280 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12281 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12282 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12283 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012284 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12285
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012286tls-tickets
12287 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12288 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12289 default value.
12290 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12291 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012292
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012293verify [none|required]
12294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012295 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012296 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12297 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012298 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012299 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12300 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12301 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12302 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12303 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12304 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12305 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12306 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012307
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012308verifyhost <hostname>
12309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012310 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12311 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12312 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12313 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12314 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12315 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12316 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12317 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012319weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012320 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12321 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12322 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012323 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12324 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12325 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12326 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12327 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12328 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012329
12330
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123315.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12332-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012333
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012334HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12335using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12336configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012337This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12338can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12339workload.
12340This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12341resolution at run time.
12342Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12343carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12344
12345
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123465.3.1. Global overview
12347----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012348
12349As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12350different steps of the process life:
12351
12352 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12353 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12354 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12355
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012356 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12357 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012358
12359A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12360 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12361 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12362 resolution to know this new IP.
12363
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012364When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012365HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012366SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12367from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12368will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12369will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012370
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012371A few things important to notice:
12372 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12373 first valid response.
12374
12375 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12376 servers return an error.
12377
12378
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123795.3.2. The resolvers section
12380----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012381
12382This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012383HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12384contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012385
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012386When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12387uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12388is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12389answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12390
12391When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012392used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012393
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012394 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12395 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12396 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012397
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012398 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12399 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012400
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012401 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12402 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12403 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012404
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012405For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12406following scenarios are possible:
12407
12408 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12409 ignored
12410
12411 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12412 applied
12413
12414 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12415 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12416
12417 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12418 retries the query with a new type
12419
12420 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12421 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012422
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012423As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12424a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012425<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012426
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012427
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012428resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012429 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012430
12431A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12432
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012433accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012434 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012435 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012436 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12437 by RFC 6891)
12438
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012439 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12440
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012441nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12442 DNS server description:
12443 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12444 <ip> : IP address of the server
12445 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12446
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012447parse-resolv-conf
12448 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12449 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12450 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12451
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012452hold <status> <period>
12453 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12454 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012455 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012456 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012457 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12458 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12459 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12460
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012461 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012462
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012463resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012464 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12465 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12466 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12467
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012468resolve_retries <nb>
12469 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12470 giving up.
12471 Default value: 3
12472
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012473 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12474 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12475 type.
12476
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012477timeout <event> <time>
12478 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12479 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12480 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012481 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12482 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012483 Default value: 1s
12484 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012485 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012486 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012487 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12488 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12489
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012490 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012491
12492 resolvers mydns
12493 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12494 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012495 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012496 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012497 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012498 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012499 hold other 30s
12500 hold refused 30s
12501 hold nx 30s
12502 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012503 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012504 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012505
12506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125076. HTTP header manipulation
12508---------------------------
12509
12510In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12511response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12512request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12513which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012514against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012515
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012516If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12517to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12518but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12519HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12520stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12521because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12522a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12523still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012525This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12526in section 4.2 :
12527
12528 - reqadd <string>
12529 - reqallow <search>
12530 - reqiallow <search>
12531 - reqdel <search>
12532 - reqidel <search>
12533 - reqdeny <search>
12534 - reqideny <search>
12535 - reqpass <search>
12536 - reqipass <search>
12537 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12538 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12539 - reqtarpit <search>
12540 - reqitarpit <search>
12541 - rspadd <string>
12542 - rspdel <search>
12543 - rspidel <search>
12544 - rspdeny <search>
12545 - rspideny <search>
12546 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12547 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12548
12549With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12550is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12551parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12552prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12553Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12554
12555 \t for a tab
12556 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12557 \n for a new line (LF)
12558 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12559 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12560 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12561 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12562 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12563
12564The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12565portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12566above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12567regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
125689 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12569is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12570
12571The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12572after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12573
12574Notes related to these keywords :
12575---------------------------------
12576 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12577 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12578 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12579
12580 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12581 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12582 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12583
12584 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12585 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12586 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12587 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12588 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12589
12590 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12591 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12592 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12593 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12594 useless headers before adding new ones.
12595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012596 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012597 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12598
12599 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12600 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12601 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12602
12603 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12604 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012605 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012606
12607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126087. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12609----------------------------------
12610
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012611HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012612client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12613The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12614these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12615but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12616data called patterns.
12617
12618
126197.1. ACL basics
12620---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012621
12622The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12623content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12624from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12625simple :
12626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012627 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012628 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012629 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12630 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012632The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12633adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012634
12635In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012637 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012638
12639This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12640Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12641and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012642an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12643conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12644as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12645are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012646
12647ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12648'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12649which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12650
12651There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12652performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012654The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12655specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12656this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012657methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12658ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012659
12660Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12661 - boolean
12662 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12663 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12664 - string
12665 - data block
12666
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012667Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12668converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12669would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12670The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12671which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12672
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012673Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12674keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12675fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12676which are summarized in the table below :
12677
12678 +---------------------+-----------------+
12679 | Sample or converter | Default |
12680 | output type | matching method |
12681 +---------------------+-----------------+
12682 | boolean | bool |
12683 +---------------------+-----------------+
12684 | integer | int |
12685 +---------------------+-----------------+
12686 | ip | ip |
12687 +---------------------+-----------------+
12688 | string | str |
12689 +---------------------+-----------------+
12690 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12691 +---------------------+-----------------+
12692
12693Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12694matching method, see below.
12695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012696The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12697 - boolean
12698 - integer or integer range
12699 - IP address / network
12700 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12701 - regular expression
12702 - hex block
12703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012704The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12705
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012706 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12707 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012708 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012709 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012710 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012711 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012712 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012714The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12715read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12716if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12717lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12718will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12719beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12720a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12721lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12722exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12723
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012724The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12725parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12726ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12727a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12728check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12729
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012730The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12731socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12732file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012734Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12735loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12736
12737 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12738
12739In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12740the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12741case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12742as well.
12743
12744The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12745sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12746do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12747methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12748is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012749obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012750followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12751default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12752that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12753string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12754
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012755The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12756By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12757string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12758resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12759server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12760waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12761flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12762function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12765sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12766be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012767
12768 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12769 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012770 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12771 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12772 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12773 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012774
12775 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12776 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012777 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012778
12779 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012780 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012781
12782 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012783 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012784
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012785 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012786 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12787
12788 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12789 binary or string samples.
12790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012791 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12792 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12795 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12796 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012798 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12799 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12802 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012804 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12805 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012807 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12808 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012809 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012811 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12812 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12813 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012814
12815For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12816request, it is possible to do :
12817
12818 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12819
12820In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12821buffer, one would use the following acl :
12822
12823 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12824
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012825On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12826possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12827
12828 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012830All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12831criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12832method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12833to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12834criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12835the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012838the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12839For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012841 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12842 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12843 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12844 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012845
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012846
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012847The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12848types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12849combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12850brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12851default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012853 +-------------------------------------------------+
12854 | Input sample type |
12855 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012856 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012857 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12858 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12859 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012860 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012861 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012862 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012864 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012866 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012867 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012868 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012869 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012870 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012871 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012872 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012873 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012874 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012875 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012876 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012877 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012878 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012879 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012880 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012881 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12882 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12883 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012884
12885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128867.1.1. Matching booleans
12887------------------------
12888
12889In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12890Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12891When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12892that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12893
12894Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12895return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12896"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12897
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128997.1.2. Matching integers
12900------------------------
12901
12902Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12903enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12904to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12905
12906Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12907matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12908lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012909
12910For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12911unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12912representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12913
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012914As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12915two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12916instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12917ranges and operators.
12918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012919For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012920operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12921Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12922of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012923
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012924Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012925
12926 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12927 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12928 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12929 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12930 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12931
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012932For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012933
12934 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12935
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012936This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12937
12938 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129417.1.3. Matching strings
12942-----------------------
12943
12944String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12945different forms :
12946
12947 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012948 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012949
12950 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012951 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012952
12953 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12954 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12955
12956 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12957 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12958
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012959 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012960 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12961 matches.
12962
12963 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12964 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12965 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012966
12967String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12968exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12969characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12970string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12971to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012972before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012973
12974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129757.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12976---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012977
12978Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12979they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12980possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12981passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12982the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012983the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12984match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012985
12986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129877.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12988-------------------------------------
12989
12990It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12991not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12992a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12993to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12994digits may be used upper or lower case.
12995
12996Example :
12997 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12998 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12999
13000
130017.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13002---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013003
13004IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13005netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13006within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013007host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013008difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13009at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13010does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13011parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013012
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013013The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13014abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13015
13016 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13017 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13018 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13019 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13020 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13021 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13022 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13023 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13024
13025Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13026192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13027
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013028IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13029Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13030trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13031IPv6 patterns.
13032
13033HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13034following situations :
13035 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13036 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13037 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13038 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13039 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13040 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13041 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13042 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13043 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13044 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013046
130477.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13048----------------------------------
13049
13050Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13051combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13052
13053 - AND (implicit)
13054 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13055 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013057A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013059 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013061Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13062indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13065"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13066requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13067is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13068
13069 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013070 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13071 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13072 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013073
13074To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13075and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13076
13077 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13078 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13079 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13080 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13081
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013082 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013083 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13084 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13085 use_backend www if host_www
13086
13087It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13088expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13089be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13090the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13091
13092 The following rule :
13093
13094 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013095 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013096
13097 Can also be written that way :
13098
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013099 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013100
13101It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13102to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13103simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13104sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13105good use is the following :
13106
13107 With named ACLs :
13108
13109 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13110 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13111 monitor fail if site_dead
13112
13113 With anonymous ACLs :
13114
13115 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13116
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013117See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13118keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013119
13120
131217.3. Fetching samples
13122---------------------
13123
13124Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13125against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13126sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13127ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13128of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13129available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13130
13131This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13132Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13133compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13134deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13135
13136The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13137matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13138method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13139indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13140
13141As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13142when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13143mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13144the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13145ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13146
13147Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13148multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13149when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013150incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13151are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013152is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13153all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13154
13155Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13156 - name
13157 - name(arg1)
13158 - name(arg1,arg2)
13159
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013160
131617.3.1. Converters
13162-----------------
13163
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013164Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13165of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13166is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13167was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013168has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013169unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13170
13171These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13172sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13173the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013174support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013175
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013176A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13177support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13178supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13179(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13180bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013182The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013183
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001318451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13185 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13186 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13187 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13188 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13189 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13190
13191 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013192 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13193 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013194 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13195 frontend http-in
13196 bind *:8081
13197 default_backend servers
13198 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13199 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13200
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013201add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013202 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013203 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013204 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13205 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013206 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013207 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13208 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13209 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13210 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013211 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013212 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013213
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013214aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13215 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13216 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13217 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13218 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13219 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13220 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13221
13222 Example:
13223 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13224 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13225
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013226and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013227 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013228 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013229 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13230 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013231 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013232 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13233 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13234 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13235 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013236 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013237 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013238
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013239b64dec
13240 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13241 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13242
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013243base64
13244 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013245 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013246 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13247
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013248bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013249 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013250 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013251 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013252 presence of a flag).
13253
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013254bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13255 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13256 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013257 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013258
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013259concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13260 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13261 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13262 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13263 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13264 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13265 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13266 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13267 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13268 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13269 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13270 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13271 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13272 delimitors.
13273
13274 Example:
13275 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13276 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13277 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13278 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13279
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013280cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013281 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13282 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013283
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013284crc32([<avalanche>])
13285 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13286 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13287 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13288 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13289 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13290 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13291 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13292 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13293 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13294 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013295 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13296
13297crc32c([<avalanche>])
13298 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13299 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13300 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13301 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13302 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13303 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13304 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13305 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013306
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013307da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013308 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13309 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13310 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13311 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013312 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013313 configuration language.
13314
13315 Example:
13316 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013317 bind *:8881
13318 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013319 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013320
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013321debug
13322 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13323 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13324 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13325
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013326div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013327 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13328 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013329 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013330 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13331 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013332 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013333 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13334 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13335 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13336 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013337 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013338 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013339
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013340djb2([<avalanche>])
13341 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13342 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13343 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13344 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13345 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13346 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13347 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013348 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13349 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013350
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013351even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013352 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013353 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13354
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013355field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13356 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13357 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13358 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13359 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13360 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13361 fields.
13362
13363 Example :
13364 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13365 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13366 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13367 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13368 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013369
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013370hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013371 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013372 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013373 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013374 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013375
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013376hex2i
13377 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13378 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13379
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013380http_date([<offset>])
13381 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13382 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13383 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13384 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13385 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13386 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013387
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013388in_table(<table>)
13389 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13390 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13391 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013392 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013393 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13394
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013395ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13396 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013397 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013398 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13399 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13400 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13401 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13402 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013403
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013404json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013405 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013406 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013407 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013408 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13409 of errors:
13410 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13411 bytes, ...)
13412 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13413 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13414
13415 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13416 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13417 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13418 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13419 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13420 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013421 - "ascii" : never fails;
13422 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13423 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013424 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013425 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013426 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13427 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13428
13429 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013430 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013431
13432 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013433 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013434 capture request header user-agent len 150
13435 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013436
13437 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13438 GET / HTTP/1.0
13439 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13440
13441 Output log:
13442 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13443
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013444language(<value>[,<default>])
13445 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13446 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13447 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13448 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13449 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13450 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13451 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13452 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13453 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013454 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013455 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13456 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013457
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013458 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013459
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013460 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13461 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013462
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013463 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13464 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13465 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13466 use_backend spanish if es
13467 use_backend french if fr
13468 use_backend english if en
13469 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013470
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013471length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013472 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13473 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13474 type. The result is of type integer.
13475
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013476lower
13477 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13478 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13479 type. The result is of type string.
13480
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013481ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13482 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13483 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13484 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13485 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13486 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13487 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13488
13489 Example :
13490
13491 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013492 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013493 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013495map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13496map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13497map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13498 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13499 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13500 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13501 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13502 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13503 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13504 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13505 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013506
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013507 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13508 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13509 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013510
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013511 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013512 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013513
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013514 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13515 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13516 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13517 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013518 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13519 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013520 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13521 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13522 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13523 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13524 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13525 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13526 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13527 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013528 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13529 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13530 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013531 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13532 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13533 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13534 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13535 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013536
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013537 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13538 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13539 the corresponding match text.
13540
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013541 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13542 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13543 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13544 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13545 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013546
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013547 Example :
13548
13549 # this is a comment and is ignored
13550 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13551 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13552 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13553 | | | `---------- value
13554 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13555 | `---------------------------- key
13556 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13557
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013558mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013559 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13560 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013561 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013562 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013563 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013564 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13565 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13566 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13567 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013568 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013569 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013570
13571mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013572 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013573 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13574 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013575 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013576 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013577 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013578 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13579 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13580 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13581 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013582 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013583 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013584
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013585nbsrv
13586 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13587 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13588 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13589 map lookup.
13590
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013591neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013592 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13593 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13594 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13595 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013596
13597not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013598 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013599 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013600 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013601 absence of a flag).
13602
13603odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013604 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013605 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13606
13607or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013608 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013609 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013610 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13611 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013612 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013613 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13614 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13615 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13616 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013617 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013618 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013619
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013620protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13621 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13622 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13623 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13624 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13625 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13626 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13627 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13628 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13629 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13630 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13631 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13632
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013633regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013634 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13635 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13636 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13637 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13638 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13639 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13640 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13641 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13642 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13643 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013644 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13645 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13646 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13647 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013648
13649 Example :
13650
13651 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13652 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13653 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13654 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13655
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013656capture-req(<id>)
13657 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13658 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13659
13660 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013661 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13662 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013663
13664capture-res(<id>)
13665 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13666 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13667
13668 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013669 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13670 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013671
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013672sdbm([<avalanche>])
13673 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13674 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13675 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13676 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13677 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13678 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13679 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013680 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13681 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013682
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013683set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013684 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13685 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13686 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013687 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013688 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13689 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013690 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013691 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13692 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013693 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013694 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013695
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013696sha1
13697 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13698 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13699
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013700strcmp(<var>)
13701 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13702 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13703 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13704 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13705 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13706 shorter).
13707
13708 Example :
13709
13710 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13711 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13712 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13713
13714
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013715sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013716 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13717 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013718 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013719 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13720 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013721 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013722 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13723 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013724 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013725 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13726 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013727 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013728 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013729
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013730table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13731 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13732 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13733 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13734 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13735 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13736 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13737
13738
13739table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13740 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13741 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13742 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13743 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13744 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13745 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13746
13747table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13748 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13749 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013751 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13752 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13753
13754table_conn_cur(<table>)
13755 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13756 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13757 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13758 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13759 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13760
13761table_conn_rate(<table>)
13762 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13763 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13764 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13765 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13766 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13767
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013768table_gpt0(<table>)
13769 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13770 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13771 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13772 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13773 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13774
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013775table_gpc0(<table>)
13776 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13777 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13778 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13779 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13780 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13781
13782table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13783 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13784 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13785 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13786 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13787 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13788 sample fetch keyword.
13789
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013790table_gpc1(<table>)
13791 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13792 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13793 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13794 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13795 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13796
13797table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13798 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13799 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13800 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13801 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13802 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13803 sample fetch keyword.
13804
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013805table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013809 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13810 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13811
13812table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13813 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13814 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13815 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13816 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13817 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13818 keyword.
13819
13820table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13821 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13822 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013823 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013824 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13825 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13826
13827table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13828 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13829 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13830 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13831 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13832 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13833 keyword.
13834
13835table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13836 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13837 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013838 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013839 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13840 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13841 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13842 keyword.
13843
13844table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13845 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13846 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013847 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013848 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13849 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13850 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13851 keyword.
13852
13853table_server_id(<table>)
13854 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13855 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13856 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13857 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13858 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13859 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13860
13861table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13862 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13863 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013865 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13866 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13867 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13868 keyword.
13869
13870table_sess_rate(<table>)
13871 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13872 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13873 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13874 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13875 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13876 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13877 keyword.
13878
13879table_trackers(<table>)
13880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13883 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13884 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13885 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13886 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13887 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13888 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13889 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13890
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013891upper
13892 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13893 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13894 type. The result is of type string.
13895
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013896url_dec
13897 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13898 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13899
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013900ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013901 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013902 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13903 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13904 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013905 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13906 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13907 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13908 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013909 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013910 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13911 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013912
13913 Example:
13914 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13915 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13916
13917 message Point {
13918 int32 latitude = 1;
13919 int32 longitude = 2;
13920 }
13921
13922 message PPoint {
13923 Point point = 59;
13924 }
13925
13926 message Rectangle {
13927 // One corner of the rectangle.
13928 PPoint lo = 48;
13929 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13930 PPoint hi = 49;
13931 }
13932
13933 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13934 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13935 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13936
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013937 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13938 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13939 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
13940 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13941
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013942 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013943
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013944 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013945
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013946 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
13947 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13948 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13949
13950 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13951 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13952 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13953
13954 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13955 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13956 interpret the previous binary sample.
13957
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013958
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013959unset-var(<var name>)
13960 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13961 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13962 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13963 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13964 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13965 response),
13966 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13967 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13968 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13969 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13970
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013971utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13972 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13973 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13974 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13975 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13976 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13977 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13978
13979 Example :
13980
13981 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013982 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013983 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13984
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013985word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13986 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13987 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13988 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13989 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13990 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13991
13992 Example :
13993 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13994 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13995 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13996 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13997 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013998
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013999wt6([<avalanche>])
14000 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14001 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14002 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14003 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14004 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14005 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14006 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014007 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14008 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014009
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014010xor(<value>)
14011 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014012 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014013 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014014 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014015 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014016 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14017 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014018 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014019 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14020 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014021 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014022 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014023
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014024xxh32([<seed>])
14025 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14026 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14027 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14028 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14029 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14030 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14031 as cryptographically secure.
14032
14033xxh64([<seed>])
14034 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14035 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14036 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14037 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14038 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14039 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14040 as cryptographically secure.
14041
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014042
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140437.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014044--------------------------------------------
14045
14046A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14047not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14048"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14049The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14050
14051always_false : boolean
14052 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14053 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14054
14055always_true : boolean
14056 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14057 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14058
14059avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014060 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014061 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14062 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14063 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14064 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14065 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14066 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14067 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14068 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14069 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14070 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14071 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14072 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14073 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014075be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014076 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14077 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14078 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14079 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014080 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14081
14082be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14083 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14084 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14085 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14086 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14087 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014088 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14089 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014090
14091 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14092 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14093 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014095be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14096 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14097 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14098 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014099 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014100 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14101 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014102
14103 Example :
14104 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14105 backend dynamic
14106 mode http
14107 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14108 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014109
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014110bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014111 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14112 of the string.
14113
14114bool(<bool>) : bool
14115 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14116 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014118connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14119 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014120 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14122 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014123
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014124 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014125 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014126 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14127
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014128 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14129 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014130
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014131 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014132 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014133 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014134 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014135 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014136 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014137 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014138
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014139 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14140 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014141 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014142 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014143
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014144cpu_calls : integer
14145 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14146 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14147 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14148 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14149 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14150 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14151
14152cpu_ns_avg : integer
14153 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14154 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14155 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14156 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14157 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14158 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14159 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14160 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14161 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14162 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14163 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14164
14165cpu_ns_tot : integer
14166 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14167 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14168 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14169 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14170 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14171 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14172 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14173 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14174 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14175 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14176 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14177 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14178 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14179
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014180date([<offset>]) : integer
14181 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14182 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14183 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14184 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014185 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14186
14187 Example :
14188
14189 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14190 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014191
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014192date_us : integer
14193 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14194 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14195 from the same timeval structure.
14196
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014197distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14198 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14199 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14200 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14201 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14202 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14203 list of supported tokens.
14204
14205distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14206 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14207 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14208 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14209 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14210 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14211 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14212 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14213 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14214 supported tokens.
14215
14216 Example :
14217 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14218 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14219 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14220 # send large files to the big farm
14221 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14222
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014223env(<name>) : string
14224 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14225 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14226 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14227 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14228 certain way.
14229
14230 Examples :
14231 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14232 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14233
14234 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14235 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014237fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14238 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014239 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14240 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014241 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14242 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014243 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14245 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014246
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014247fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14248 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14249 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14250 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14253 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14254 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14255 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14256 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14257 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14258 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14259 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14260 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014261
14262 Example :
14263 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14264 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14265 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14266 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14267 frontend mail
14268 bind :25
14269 mode tcp
14270 maxconn 100
14271 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14272 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14273 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14274 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014275
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014276hostname : string
14277 Returns the system hostname.
14278
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014279int(<integer>) : signed integer
14280 Returns a signed integer.
14281
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014282ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14283 Returns an ipv4.
14284
14285ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14286 Returns an ipv6.
14287
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014288lat_ns_avg : integer
14289 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14290 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14291 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14292 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14293 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14294 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14295 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14296 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14297 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14298 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14299 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14300 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14301 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14302 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14303
14304lat_ns_tot : integer
14305 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14306 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14307 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14308 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14309 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14310 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14311 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14312 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14313 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14314 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14315 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14316 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14317 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14318 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14319 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14320 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14321 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14322 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14323 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14324
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014325meth(<method>) : method
14326 Returns a method.
14327
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014328nbproc : integer
14329 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14330 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14331 and debugging purposes.
14332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014333nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14334 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14335 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14336 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014337 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14338 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14339 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014340
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014341prio_class : integer
14342 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14343 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14344 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14345
14346prio_offset : integer
14347 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14348 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14349 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14350 set-priority-offset".
14351
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014352proc : integer
14353 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14354 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14355 debugging purposes.
14356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014357queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014358 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14359 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14360 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014361 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14362 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14363 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14364 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14365 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14366
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014367rand([<range>]) : integer
14368 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14369 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14370 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14371 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14372 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014374srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14376 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14377 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14378 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14379 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014380 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14381 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14382
14383srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14384 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14385 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14386 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14387 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14388 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14389 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14390 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14391
14392 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14393 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394
14395srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14396 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14397 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14398 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014399 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014400 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14401 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14402 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14403
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014404srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14405 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14406 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14407 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14408 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14409 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14410 fetch methods.
14411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14413 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14414 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014415 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014416 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14417 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014418 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014419 overloading servers).
14420
14421 Example :
14422 # Redirect to a separate back
14423 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14424 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14425 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14426
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014427stopping : boolean
14428 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14429 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14430 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14431
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014432str(<string>) : string
14433 Returns a string.
14434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14436 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14437 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14438
14439table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14440 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14441 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14442 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14443
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014444thread : integer
14445 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14446 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14447 and debugging purposes.
14448
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014449var(<var-name>) : undefined
14450 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014451 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14452 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014453 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014454 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14455 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014456 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014457 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14458 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014459 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014460 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014461
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144627.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014463----------------------------------
14464
14465The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14466closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14467methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14468sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14469TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014470the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14471counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014472"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14473used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14474can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14475Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14476table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14477tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14478currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014479
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014480bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014481 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14482 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14483 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014485be_id : integer
14486 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14487 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14488
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014489be_name : string
14490 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14491 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014493dst : ip
14494 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14495 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14496 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14497 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014498 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14499 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14500 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14501 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14502 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14503 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014504
14505dst_conn : integer
14506 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14507 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14508 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14509 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14510 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14511 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14512 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14513 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014514
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014515dst_is_local : boolean
14516 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14517 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14518 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14519 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014520 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014521 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14522 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14523 it only once per connection.
14524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525dst_port : integer
14526 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14527 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14528 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14529 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14530 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14531 an HTTP header.
14532
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014533fc_http_major : integer
14534 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14535 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14536 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14537
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014538fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14539 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14540 header.
14541
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014542fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14543 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14544 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14545 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14546 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14547 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14548 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14549
14550fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14551 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14552 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14553 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14554 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14555 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14556 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14557
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014558fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14559 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14560 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14561 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14562 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14563
14564fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14565 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14566 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14567 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14568 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14569
14570fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14571 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14572 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14573 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14574 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14575
14576fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14577 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14578 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14579 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14580 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14581
14582fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14583 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14584 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14585 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14586 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14587
14588fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14589 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14590 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14591 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14592 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14593
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014594fe_defbe : string
14595 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14596 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014598fe_id : integer
14599 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014600 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14602
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014603fe_name : string
14604 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14605 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14606 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14607
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014608sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014609sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14610sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14611sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014612 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14613 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14614 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14615
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014616sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014617sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14618sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14619sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014620 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14621 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14622 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14623
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014624sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014625sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14626sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14627sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014628 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14629 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014630 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14631 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14632 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014633
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014634 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014635 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14636 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014637 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14638 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14639 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014640 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14641 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14642
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014643sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14644sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14645sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14646sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14647 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14648 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14649 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14650 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14651 when a first ACL was verified.
14652
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014653sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014654sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14655sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14656sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014657 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014658 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14659
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014660sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014661sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14662sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14663sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014664 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14665 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14666 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14667
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014668sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014669sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14670sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14671sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014672 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14673 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14674 See also src_conn_rate.
14675
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014676sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014677sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14678sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14679sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014680 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014681 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014682
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014683sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14684sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14685sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14686sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14687 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14688 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14689
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014690sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14691sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14692sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14693sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14694 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14695 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14696
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014697sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014698sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14699sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14700sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014701 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14702 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14703 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014704 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14705 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14706 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014707
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014708sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14709sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14710sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14711sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14712 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14713 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14714 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14715 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14716 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14717 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14718
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014719sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014720sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14721sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14722sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014723 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014724 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14725 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14726
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014727sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014728sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14729sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14730sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014731 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14732 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14733 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14734 src_http_err_rate.
14735
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014736sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014737sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14738sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14739sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014740 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014741 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14742 src_http_req_cnt.
14743
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014744sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014745sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14746sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14747sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014748 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14749 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14750 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14751 src_http_req_rate.
14752
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014753sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014754sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14755sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14756sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014757 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014758 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14759 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14760 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14761 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014762
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014763 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014764 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14765 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014766 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14767
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014768sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14769sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14770sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14771sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14772 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14773 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14774 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14775 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14776 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14777
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014778sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014779sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14780sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14781sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014782 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14783 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14784 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014785
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014786sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014787sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14788sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14789sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014790 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14791 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14792 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014793
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014794sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014795sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14796sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14797sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014798 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014799 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14800 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14801 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014802 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014803 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14804
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014805sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014806sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14807sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14808sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014809 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14810 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14811 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14812 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14813 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014814 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014816sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014817sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14818sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14819sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014820 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14821 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14822 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14823
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014824sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014825sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14826sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14827sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014828 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14829 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014830 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014831 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14832 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014833 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14834 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14835 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837so_id : integer
14838 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14839 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14840 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014843 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14845 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14846 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014847 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14848 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14849 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014850 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14851 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14852 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14853 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14854 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14855 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14856 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014857
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014858 Example:
14859 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14860 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14863 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14864 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14865 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014866 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14869 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14870 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014871 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014872 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14875 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14876 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14877 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14878 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14879 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14880 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014881
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014882 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014883 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14884 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14885 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14886 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014887 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014888 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14889 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14890
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014891src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14892 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14893 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14894 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14895 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14896 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14897 was verified.
14898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014900 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014901 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014902 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014903 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014905src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014906 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14908 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014909 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14912 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14913 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14914 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014915 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014917src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014918 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014920 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014921 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014922
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014923src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14924 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14925 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14926 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14927 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14928
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014929src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14930 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14931 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14932 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14933 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014935src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014936 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014937 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014938 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14939 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014940 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14941 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14942 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014943
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014944src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14945 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14946 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14947 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14948 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14949 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14950 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14951 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014954 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014956 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014957 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014958 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014960src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14961 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14962 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14963 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14964 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014965 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014968 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14970 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014971 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14974 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14975 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14976 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014977 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014978 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14981 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14982 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14983 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014984 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14986 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014987
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014988 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014989 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014990 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014991 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014992
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014993src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14994 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14995 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14996 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14997 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14998 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14999 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15000
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015001src_is_local : boolean
15002 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15003 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15004 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15005 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015006 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015007 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15008 once per connection.
15009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015010src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015011 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15012 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15013 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15014 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15015 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015018 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15019 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15020 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15021 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15022 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015024src_port : integer
15025 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15026 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15027 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15028 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015030src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015031 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015032 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15033 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15034 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015035 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15038 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15039 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15040 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15041 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015042 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015044src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15045 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15046 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15047 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15048 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15049 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15050 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15051 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15052 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015053
15054 Example :
15055 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15056 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15057 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15058 listen ssh
15059 bind :22
15060 mode tcp
15061 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015062 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015063 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015064 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066srv_id : integer
15067 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15068 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15069 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015070
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150717.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15075closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15076when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15077usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015078future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015079
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001508051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15081 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15082 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15083 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15084 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15085 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15086
15087 Example :
15088 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15089 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15090 # the request.
15091 frontend http-in
15092 bind *:8081
15093 default_backend servers
15094 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15095 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15096
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015097ssl_bc : boolean
15098 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15099 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15100 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15101
15102ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15103 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15104 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15105
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015106ssl_bc_alpn : string
15107 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15108 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15109 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15110 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15111 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15112 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15113 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15114 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15115 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15116
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015117ssl_bc_cipher : string
15118 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15119 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15120
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015121ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15122 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15123 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15124 session or a TLS ticket.
15125
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015126ssl_bc_npn : string
15127 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15128 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15129 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15130 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15131 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15132 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15133 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15134 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15135
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015136ssl_bc_protocol : string
15137 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15138 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15139
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015140ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015141 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015142 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15143 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015144
15145ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15146 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15147 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15148 if session was reused or not.
15149
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015150ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15151 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15152 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15153 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15154 BoringSSL.
15155
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015156ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15157 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15158 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15161 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15162 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15163 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15164 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15165 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015167ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15168 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15169 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15170 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15171 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015172
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015173ssl_c_der : binary
15174 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15175 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15176 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178ssl_c_err : integer
15179 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15180 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15181 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15182 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15183 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015185ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15186 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15187 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15188 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15189 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15190 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15191 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15192 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15193 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195ssl_c_key_alg : string
15196 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15197 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15198 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200ssl_c_notafter : string
15201 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15202 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15203 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205ssl_c_notbefore : string
15206 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15207 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15208 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015210ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15211 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15212 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15213 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15214 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15215 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15216 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15217 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15218 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015220ssl_c_serial : binary
15221 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15222 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15223 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015225ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15226 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15227 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15228 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015229 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15230 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15231
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015232 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015233 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015235ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15236 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15237 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15238 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015240ssl_c_used : boolean
15241 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15242 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015244ssl_c_verify : integer
15245 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15246 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15247 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15248 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250ssl_c_version : integer
15251 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15252 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015253
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015254ssl_f_der : binary
15255 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15256 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15257 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15260 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15261 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15262 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15263 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015264 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015265 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15266 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15267 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269ssl_f_key_alg : string
15270 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15271 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15272 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274ssl_f_notafter : string
15275 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15276 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15277 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279ssl_f_notbefore : string
15280 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15281 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15282 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015284ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15285 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15286 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15287 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15288 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15289 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15290 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15291 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15292 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015294ssl_f_serial : binary
15295 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15296 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15297 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015298
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015299ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15300 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15301 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15302 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15305 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15306 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15307 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309ssl_f_version : integer
15310 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15311 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15312
15313ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015314 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15315 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15316 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318 Example :
15319 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15320 listen http-https
15321 bind :80
15322 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15323 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15324
15325ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15326 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15327 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15328
15329ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015330 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15332 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15333 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15334 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15335 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15336 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15337 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15338 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340ssl_fc_cipher : string
15341 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15342 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015343
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015344ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15345 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15346 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015347 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015348
15349ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15350 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15351 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015352 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015353
15354ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15355 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15356 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15357 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015358 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015359 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015360
15361ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15362 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15363 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015364 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015367 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15368 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015369 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15370 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15371 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15372 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015373
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015374ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15375 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15376 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15377 wait until the handshake happened.
15378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015379ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15380 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015381 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15382 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15383 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15384 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015385
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015386ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015387 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015388 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15389 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015391ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015392 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15394 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15395 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15396 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15397 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15398 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15399 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015401ssl_fc_protocol : string
15402 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15403 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015404
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015405ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015406 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015407 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15408 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015410ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15411 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15412 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15413 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15414 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015415
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015416ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15417 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15418 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15419 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15420 BoringSSL.
15421
15422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015423ssl_fc_sni : string
15424 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15425 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15426 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15427 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15428 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15429
15430 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15431 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15432 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015433 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15434 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015436 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15438 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15441 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15442 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015443
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015444
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154457.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15449sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15450only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15451For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15452be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15453can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15454sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15455for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15456content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015459 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15461 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15464 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015465 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015467
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015468req.hdrs : string
15469 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15470 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15471 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15472 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15473
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015474req.hdrs_bin : binary
15475 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15476 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15477 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15478 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15479 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15480 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15481
15482 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15483
15484 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15485 str: <int:length><bytes>
15486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487req.len : integer
15488req_len : integer (deprecated)
15489 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15490 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15491 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15492 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15493 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15494 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15495 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15496 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15499 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015500 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15501 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15502 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15503 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015505 ACL alternatives :
15506 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15509 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15510 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15511 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15512 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514 ACL alternatives :
15515 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519req.proto_http : boolean
15520req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15521 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15522 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15523 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15524 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15525 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15526 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15527 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529 Example:
15530 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15531 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15532 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015533 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15536rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15537 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15538 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15539 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15540 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15541 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15542 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15543 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15546 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15547 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15548 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15549 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15550 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552 ACL derivatives :
15553 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555 Example :
15556 listen tse-farm
15557 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15558 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15559 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15560 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15561 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15562 persist rdp-cookie
15563 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15564 # This is only useful makes sense if
15565 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15566 stick-table type string size 204800
15567 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15568 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15569 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15572 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15575rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15576 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15577 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15578 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15579 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581 ACL derivatives :
15582 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015583
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015584req.ssl_alpn : string
15585 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15586 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15587 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15588 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15589 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15590 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015591 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015592
15593 Examples :
15594 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15595 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15596 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015597 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015598 default_backend bk_default
15599
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015600req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15601 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15602 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015603 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15604 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15605 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15606 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15607 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15610req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15611 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15612 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15613 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15614 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15615 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15616 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15617 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619req.ssl_sni : string
15620req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15621 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15622 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15623 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15624 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15625 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15626 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15627 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15628 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15629 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15630 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15631 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15632 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634 ACL derivatives :
15635 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 Examples :
15638 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15639 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15640 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15641 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15642 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015643
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015644req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15645 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15646 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15647 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15648 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15649 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15650 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15651 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15652 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15653 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655req.ssl_ver : integer
15656req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15657 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15658 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15659 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15660 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15661 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15662 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15663 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015664 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667 ACL derivatives :
15668 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015669
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015670res.len : integer
15671 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15672 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15673 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15674 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15675 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15676 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15677 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15678 content inspection.
15679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15681 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015682 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15683 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15684 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15685 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15688 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15689 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15690 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15691 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015694
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015695res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15696rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15697 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15698 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15699 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15700 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15701 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15702 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15703 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705wait_end : boolean
15706 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15707 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015708 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15710 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015711 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15713 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 Examples :
15716 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15717 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15718 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15721 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15722 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15723 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15724 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15725 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15726 tcp-request content reject
15727
15728
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157297.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730--------------------------------------
15731
15732It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15733This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15734data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15735its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15736HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15737content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15738to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15739more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15740response are indexed.
15741
15742base : string
15743 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15744 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15745 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15746 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15747 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15748 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15749 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15750 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15751
15752 ACL derivatives :
15753 base : exact string match
15754 base_beg : prefix match
15755 base_dir : subdir match
15756 base_dom : domain match
15757 base_end : suffix match
15758 base_len : length match
15759 base_reg : regex match
15760 base_sub : substring match
15761
15762base32 : integer
15763 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15764 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15765 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015766 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15767 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15768 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769
15770base32+src : binary
15771 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15772 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15773 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15774 per-URL counters.
15775
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015776capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15777 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15778 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15779 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15780
15781capture.req.method : string
15782 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15783 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15784 because it's allocated.
15785
15786capture.req.uri : string
15787 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15788 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15789 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15790 allocated.
15791
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015792capture.req.ver : string
15793 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15794 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15795 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15796
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015797capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15798 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15799 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15800 The first entry is an index of 0.
15801 See also: "capture response header"
15802
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015803capture.res.ver : string
15804 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15805 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15806 persistent flag.
15807
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015808req.body : binary
15809 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15810 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15811 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15812 the first chunk is analyzed.
15813
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015814req.body_param([<name>) : string
15815 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15816 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15817 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15818 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15819 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15820 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15821 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15822 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15823 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15824 given.
15825
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015826req.body_len : integer
15827 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15828 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15829 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15830 "option http-buffer-request".
15831
15832req.body_size : integer
15833 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15834 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15835 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15836 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15837 "option http-buffer-request".
15838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015839req.cook([<name>]) : string
15840cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15841 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15842 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15843 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15844 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15845 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15846 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15847 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15848 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15849
15850 ACL derivatives :
15851 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15852 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15853 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15854 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15855 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15856 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15857 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15858 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015860req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15861cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15862 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15863 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15866cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15867 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15868 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15869 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15870 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15873 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15874 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15875 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15876 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015877 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15879 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15880 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15881 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015883hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15884 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15885 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15886 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15887 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015888 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15891 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15892 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15893 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15894 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15895 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15896 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15897 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15898 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15901 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15902 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15903 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15904 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15907 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15908 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15909 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15910 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15911 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15912 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15913 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15914 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015915 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015917 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919 ACL derivatives :
15920 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15921 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15922 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15923 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15924 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15925 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15926 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15927 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15928
15929req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15930hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15931 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15932 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15933 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15934 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15935 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15936 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15937 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15938 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15939 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15940
15941req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15942hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15943 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15944 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15945 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15946 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15947 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015948 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15950 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15951
15952req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15953hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15954 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15955 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15956 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15957 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15958 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15959 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15960 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15961
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015962
15963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15965 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15966 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15967 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15968 basic auth is supported.
15969
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015970http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15971 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15972 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15973 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15974 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15976 basic auth is supported.
15977
15978 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015979 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15980 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15981 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15982 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015983
15984http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015985 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15986 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15988 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990method : integer + string
15991 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15992 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15993 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15994 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15995 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15996 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15997 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999 ACL derivatives :
16000 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002 Example :
16003 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16004 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16005 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007path : string
16008 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16009 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16010 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16011 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16012 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016013 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016 ACL derivatives :
16017 path : exact string match
16018 path_beg : prefix match
16019 path_dir : subdir match
16020 path_dom : domain match
16021 path_end : suffix match
16022 path_len : length match
16023 path_reg : regex match
16024 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016025
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016026query : string
16027 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16028 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16029 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16030 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016031 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016032 which stops before the question mark.
16033
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016034req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16035 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16036 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16037 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16038 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040req.ver : string
16041req_ver : string (deprecated)
16042 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16043 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16044 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046 ACL derivatives :
16047 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049res.comp : boolean
16050 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16051 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16052 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054res.comp_algo : string
16055 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16056 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16057 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059res.cook([<name>]) : string
16060scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16061 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16062 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16063 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016065 ACL derivatives :
16066 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016068res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16069scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16070 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16071 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16072 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16075scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16076 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16077 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16078 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16081 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16082 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16083 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16084 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16085 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16086 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16087 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16088 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16089 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16092 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16093 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16094 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16095 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16096 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16099shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16100 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16101 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16102 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16103 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16104 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16105 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16106 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16107 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109 ACL derivatives :
16110 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16111 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16112 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16113 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16114 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16115 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16116 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16117 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16118
16119res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16120shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16121 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16122 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16123 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16124 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16125 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16128shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16129 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16130 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16131 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16132 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16133 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16134 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016135
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016136res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16137 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16138 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16139 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16140 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016142res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16143shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16144 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16145 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16146 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16147 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16148 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16149 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151res.ver : string
16152resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16153 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16154 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156 ACL derivatives :
16157 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16160 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16161 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016162 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016165 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16166 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168status : integer
16169 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16170 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16171 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016172
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016173unique-id : string
16174 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16175 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16176 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16177 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16178 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16179 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181url : string
16182 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16183 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16184 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16185 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16186 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16187 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16188 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190 ACL derivatives :
16191 url : exact string match
16192 url_beg : prefix match
16193 url_dir : subdir match
16194 url_dom : domain match
16195 url_end : suffix match
16196 url_len : length match
16197 url_reg : regex match
16198 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200url_ip : ip
16201 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16202 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16203 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16204 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16205 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16206 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16207 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209url_port : integer
16210 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16211 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16212 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16213 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016214
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016215urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16216url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016217 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16218 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016219 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16220 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16221 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16222 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16224 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016225 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16226 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228 ACL derivatives :
16229 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16230 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16231 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16232 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16233 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16234 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16235 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16236 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016237
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016239 Example :
16240 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16241 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16242 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16243 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016244
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016245urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16247 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16248 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016249
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016250url32 : integer
16251 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16252 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16253 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16254 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16255 is an unsigned integer.
16256
16257url32+src : binary
16258 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16259 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16260 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16261
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162637.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016264---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016266Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16267every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016268order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016270ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16271---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016272FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016273HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016274HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16275HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016276HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16277HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16278HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16279HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16280LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016281METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016282METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016283METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16284METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16285METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16286METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016287METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016288METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016289RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016290REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016291TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016292WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16293---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016294
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162968. Logging
16297----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016298
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016299One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16300provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16301very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16302provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16303state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016304to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016305headers.
16306
16307In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16308about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16309send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16310
16311 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16312 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16313 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16314 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16315 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016316 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016317 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016318
16319The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16320allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16321as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16322while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16323real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16324delay.
16325
16326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163278.1. Log levels
16328---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016329
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016330TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016331source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016332HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16333in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16334track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16335syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16336about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016337
16338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163398.2. Log formats
16340----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016341
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016342HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016343and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16344slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16345options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016346
16347 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16348 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16349 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16350 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16351 extents.
16352
16353 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16354 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16355 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16356 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16357 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16358
16359 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16360 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16361 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16362 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16363 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16364
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016365 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16366 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16367 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16368 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16369
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016370 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16371
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016372Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16373specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16374field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16375servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16376always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16377identifier.
16378
16379Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16380 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16381 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16382 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16383 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16384
16385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163868.2.1. Default log format
16387-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016388
16389This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16390as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16391format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16392
16393 Example :
16394 listen www
16395 mode http
16396 log global
16397 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16398
16399 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16400 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16401 (www/HTTP)
16402
16403 Field Format Extract from the example above
16404 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16405 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16406 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16407 4 'to' to
16408 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16409 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16410
16411Detailed fields description :
16412 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16413 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16414 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16415 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16416 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16417 and processed the connection.
16418 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16419
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016420In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16421"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16422connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16423
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016424It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16425will eventually disappear.
16426
16427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164288.2.2. TCP log format
16429---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016430
16431The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16432is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16433information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16434counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16435emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16436environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16437the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16438sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016439specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16440not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16441fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16442marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016443
16444 Example :
16445 frontend fnt
16446 mode tcp
16447 option tcplog
16448 log global
16449 default_backend bck
16450
16451 backend bck
16452 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16453
16454 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16455 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16456 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16457
16458 Field Format Extract from the example above
16459 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16460 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16461 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16462 4 frontend_name fnt
16463 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16464 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16465 7 bytes_read* 212
16466 8 termination_state --
16467 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16468 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16469
16470Detailed fields description :
16471 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016472 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16473 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16474 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016475 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016476 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016477 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016478
16479 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016480 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16481 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16482 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016483
16484 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16485 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16486 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016487 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16488 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16489 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16490 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016491
16492 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16493 and processed the connection.
16494
16495 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16496 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16497 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16498 applications.
16499
16500 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16501 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16502 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16503 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16504 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16505
16506 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16507 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16508 See "Timers" below for more details.
16509
16510 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16511 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16512 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16513 "Timers" below for more details.
16514
16515 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016516 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016517 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16518 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16519 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16520 details.
16521
16522 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16523 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16524 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16525 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16526 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16527
16528 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16529 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16530 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16531 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16532 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16533 for more details.
16534
16535 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016536 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016537 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16538 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16539 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016540 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016541
16542 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16543 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16544 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16545 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16546 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16547 caused by a denial of service attack.
16548
16549 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16550 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16551 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16552 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16553 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16554 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16555 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16556 denial of service attack.
16557
16558 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16559 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16560 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16561 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16562 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16563 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16564 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16565 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16566 be processed than on other servers.
16567
16568 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16569 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16570 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16571 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16572 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16573 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16574 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16575 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16576 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16577 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16578 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16579 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16580 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16581
16582 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16583 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16584 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16585 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16586 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16587 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016588 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016589 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16590
16591 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16592 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16593 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16594 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16595 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16596 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016597 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016598 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16599 occurs.
16600
16601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166028.2.3. HTTP log format
16603----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016604
16605The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16606is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16607the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16608are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16609emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16610generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16611"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16612which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016613frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16614is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016615
16616Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16617slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16618with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16619
16620 Example :
16621 frontend http-in
16622 mode http
16623 option httplog
16624 log global
16625 default_backend bck
16626
16627 backend static
16628 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16629
16630 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16631 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16632 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016633 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016634
16635 Field Format Extract from the example above
16636 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16637 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016638 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016639 4 frontend_name http-in
16640 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016641 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016642 7 status_code 200
16643 8 bytes_read* 2750
16644 9 captured_request_cookie -
16645 10 captured_response_cookie -
16646 11 termination_state ----
16647 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16648 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16649 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16650 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16651 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016652
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016653Detailed fields description :
16654 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016655 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16656 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16657 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016658 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016659 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016660 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016661
16662 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016663 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16664 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16665 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016666
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016667 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16668 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016669
16670 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16671 and processed the connection.
16672
16673 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16674 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16675 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16676
16677 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16678 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16679 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16680 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16681 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16682 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16683
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016684 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16685 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16686 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16687 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16688 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16689 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016690 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16691 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016692
16693 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16694 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016695 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016696
16697 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16698 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016699 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16700 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016701
16702 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16703 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16704 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16705 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16706 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016707 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16708 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016709
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016710 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16711 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16712 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16713 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16714 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16715 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16716 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016717 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016718
16719 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16720 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16721 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16722
16723 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16724 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16725 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16726 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16727 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16728 overflowing.
16729
16730 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16731 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16732 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16733 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16734 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16735 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16736 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16737 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16738
16739 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16740 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16741 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16742 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16743 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16744 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16745 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16746 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16747
16748 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16749 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16750 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16751 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16752 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16753 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16754 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16755
16756 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016757 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016758 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16759 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16760 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016761 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016762 system.
16763
16764 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16765 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16766 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16767 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16768 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16769 caused by a denial of service attack.
16770
16771 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16772 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16773 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16774 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16775 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16776 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16777 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16778 denial of service attack.
16779
16780 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16781 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16782 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16783 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16784 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16785 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16786 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16787 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16788 processed than on other servers.
16789
16790 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16791 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16792 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16793 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16794 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16795 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16796 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16797 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16798 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16799 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16800 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16801 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16802 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16803
16804 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16805 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16806 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16807 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16808 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16809 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016810 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016811 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16812
16813 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16814 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16815 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16816 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16817 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16818 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016819 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016820 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16821 occurs.
16822
16823 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16824 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16825 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16826 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16827 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16828 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16829 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16830 cookies" below for more details.
16831
16832 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16833 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16834 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16835 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16836 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16837 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16838 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16839 and cookies" below for more details.
16840
16841 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16842 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16843 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16844 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16845 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16846 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16847 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16848 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16849
16850
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168518.2.4. Custom log format
16852------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016853
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016854The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016855mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016856
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016857HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016858Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16859separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16860prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16861
16862Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16863variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016864("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016865
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016866If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016867as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016868less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16869the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16870
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016871Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016872In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016873in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016874
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016875Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16876'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16877https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16878such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16879
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016880Flags are :
16881 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016882 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016883 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16884 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016885
16886 Example:
16887
16888 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16889 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16890
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016891 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16892
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016893At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16894
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016895 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16896 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016897
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016898the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016899
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016900 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16901 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16902 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016903
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016904and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16905
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016906 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16907 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016908
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016909Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16910
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016911 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016912 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016913 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16914 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16915 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016916 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16917 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16918 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016919 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016920 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16921 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016922 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016923 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16924 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016925 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016926 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016927 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016928 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016929 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016930 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016931 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016932 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16933 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16934 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16935 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16936 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016937 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016938 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16939 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016940 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016941 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16942 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016943 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16944 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16945 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016946 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016947 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16948 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016949 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016950 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16951 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16952 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016953 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016954 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016955 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16956 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16957 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16958 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016959 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016960 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016961 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016962 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016963 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016964 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016965 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16966 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16967 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016968 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016969 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16970 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016971 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016972 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16973 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016974 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016975 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016976 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016977 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016978
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016979 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016980
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016981
169828.2.5. Error log format
16983-----------------------
16984
16985When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16986protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16987By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16988"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016989will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016990logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16991
16992The format looks like this :
16993
16994 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16995 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16996 Connection error during SSL handshake
16997
16998 Field Format Extract from the example above
16999 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17000 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17001 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17002 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17003 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17004
17005These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17006failures.
17007
17008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170098.3. Advanced logging options
17010-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017011
17012Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17013just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17014options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17015for more information about their usage.
17016
17017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170188.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17019------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017020
17021It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17022haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17023commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17024monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17025ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17026
17027 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17028 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17029 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17030 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17031
17032 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17033 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17034 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017035 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017036 such as other load-balancers.
17037
17038 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17039 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17040 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17041
17042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170438.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17044----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017045
17046The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17047what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17048or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017049"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017050just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17051log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17052after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17053is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17054with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17055with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17056
17057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170588.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17059------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017060
17061Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17062for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17063"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17064retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17065raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17066a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17067file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17068you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17069"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17070
17071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170728.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17073--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017074
17075Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17076multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17077them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17078"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17079logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17080error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17081and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17082too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17083useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17084alternative.
17085
17086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170878.4. Timing events
17088------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017089
17090Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17091reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17092the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17093frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017094mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17095addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17096
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017097Timings events in HTTP mode:
17098
17099 first request 2nd request
17100 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17101 t tr t tr ...
17102 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17103 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17104 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17105 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17106 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17107
17108Timings events in TCP mode:
17109
17110 TCP session
17111 |<----------------->|
17112 t t
17113 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17114 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17115 |<------ Tt ------->|
17116
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017117 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017118 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017119 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17120 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17121 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017122 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017123 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17124 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17125 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17126 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017127
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017128 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17129 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17130 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017131 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17132 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17133 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17134 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17135 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17136 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017137
17138 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17139 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17140 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17141 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17142 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17143 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17144 request typed by hand during a test.
17145
17146 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17147 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017148 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017149 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17150 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17151 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17152 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017153
17154 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17155 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17156 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17157 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17158 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17159
17160 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17161 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17162 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17163 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17164 connection never established.
17165
17166 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17167 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17168 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17169 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17170 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17171 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17172 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17173 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17174 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17175 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17176 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17177
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017178 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17179 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17180 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17181 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17182 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17183 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17184
17185 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17186
17187 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17188 "Ta" can never be negative.
17189
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017190 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17191 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017192 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17193 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017194 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017195
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017196 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017197
17198 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017199 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17200 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017201
17202These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17203protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17204that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017205due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17206"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17207that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017208
17209Most common cases :
17210
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017211 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17212 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17213 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17214 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17215 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17216 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17217 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17218 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17219 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17220 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17221 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017222 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017223
17224 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17225 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17226 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17227 of ms on remote networks.
17228
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017229 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17230 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17231 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017232
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017233 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17234 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17235 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17236 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17237 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17238 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17239 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17240 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17241 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017242
17243Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17244
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017245 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017246 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017247 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017248
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017249 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017250 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17251 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17252
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017253 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017254 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17255 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17256 flags.
17257
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017258 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17259 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017260 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17261 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17262 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17263 the client connection was maintained open.
17264
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017265 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017266 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017267 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017268 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17269
17270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172718.5. Session state at disconnection
17272-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017273
17274TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17275"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172762-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17277each of which has a special meaning :
17278
17279 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17280 session to terminate :
17281
17282 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17283
17284 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17285 server explicitly refused it.
17286
17287 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17288 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17289 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17290 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017291 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017292
17293 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17294 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295
17296 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17297 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17298 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17299 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17300 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17301
17302 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17303 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17304 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17305 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17306 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17307
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017308 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17309 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17310
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017311 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17312 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17313 backup connections when going up.
17314
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017315 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17316
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017317 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17318 send or receive data.
17319
17320 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17321 send or receive data.
17322
17323 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17324 with nothing left in the buffers.
17325
17326 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17327
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017328 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017329 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17330
17331 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17332 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17333 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17334 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17335 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17336
17337 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17338 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17339
17340 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17341 server (HTTP only).
17342
17343 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17344
17345 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17346 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17347 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17348
17349 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17350 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17351 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17352
17353 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17354
17355 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17356 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17357
17358 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17359 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17360 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17361
17362 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17363 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017364 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17365 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017366
17367 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17368 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17369 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17370 another server.
17371
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017372 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017373 server.
17374
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017375 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17376 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17377 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17378 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17379
17380 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17381 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17382 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17383 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17384
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017385 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17386 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17387 "use-server" rule).
17388
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017389 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17390
17391 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17392 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17393
17394 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17395
17396 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17397 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17398 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17399
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017400 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17401 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017402 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017403 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17404 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17405
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017406 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17407
17408 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17409 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17410
17411 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17412
17413 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17414
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017415The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17416was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017417helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17418starvation, attacks, etc...
17419
17420The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17421alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17422easier finding and understanding.
17423
17424 Flags Reason
17425
17426 -- Normal termination.
17427
17428 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17429 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17430 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17431 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17432
17433 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17434 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17435 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17436 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17437 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17438 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017439
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017440 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17441 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017442 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017443
17444 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17445 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17446 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17447
17448 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17449 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17450 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17451 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17452 the server takes too long to respond.
17453
17454 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17455 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17456 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17457 long a time to respond.
17458
17459 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17460 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17461 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17462 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017463 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17464 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017465
17466 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17467 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17468 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17469 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17470 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017471 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017472 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17473 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17474 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17475 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17476 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17477 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17478 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17479 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017480 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017481 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17482 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17483 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017484
17485 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17486 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017487 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17488 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17489 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17490 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017491
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017492 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17493 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017495 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017496 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17497 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017498 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017499 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17500 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17501
17502 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17503 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17504 503 or 504 here.
17505
17506 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17507 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17508 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17509 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17510 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17511
17512 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17513 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017514 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017515 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17516 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17517
17518 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17519 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17520 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17521 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17522 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17523 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17524 between haproxy and the server.
17525
17526 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17527 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17528 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17529 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17530 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17531 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17532 solution is to fix the application.
17533
17534 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17535 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17536 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17537 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17538 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17539 external attacks.
17540
17541 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17542 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017543 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17545 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17546
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017547 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17548 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17549 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017550 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017551 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017552
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017553 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17554 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17555 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17556 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017557 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17558 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17559 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17560 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17561 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562
17563 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17564 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17565 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17566 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17567
17568 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17569 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17570 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17571 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17572
17573 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17574 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17575 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17576 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17577
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017578The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17579persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17580important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17581re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17582
17583 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17584
17585 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17586 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17587 set on a GET request.
17588
17589 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17590 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017591 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017592 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17593
17594 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17595 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17596 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17597
17598 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17599 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17600 already got a cookie.
17601
17602 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17603 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17604 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17605 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17606 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17607
17608 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17609 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17610 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17611
17612 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17613 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17614 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17615
17616 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17617 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17618
17619 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17620 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17621 then advertised in the response.
17622
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176248.6. Non-printable characters
17625-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017626
17627In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17628consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17629converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17630prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17631being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17632escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17633is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17634'}' when logging headers.
17635
17636Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17637issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17638containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17639
17640Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17641the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17642performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17643
17644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176458.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17646---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017647
17648Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17649achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017650section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017651cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17652the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17653the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017654locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017655not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17656user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17657a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17658wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17659
17660 Examples :
17661 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17662 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17663
17664 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17665 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17666
17667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176688.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17669---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017670
17671Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17672proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17673the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17674server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17675
17676Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17677response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017678section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017679
17680It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017681time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17682appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017683are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17684and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17685follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17686request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17687in the logs.
17688
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017689As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17690frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17691an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17692
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017693 Example :
17694 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17695 listen proxy-out
17696 mode http
17697 option httplog
17698 option logasap
17699 log global
17700 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17701
17702 # log the name of the virtual server
17703 capture request header Host len 20
17704
17705 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17706 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17707
17708 # log the beginning of the referrer
17709 capture request header Referer len 20
17710
17711 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17712 capture response header Server len 20
17713
17714 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17715 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17716
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017717 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017718 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17719
17720 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17721 capture response header Via len 20
17722
17723 # log the URL location during a redirection
17724 capture response header Location len 20
17725
17726 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17727 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17728 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17729 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17730 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17731
17732 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17733 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17734 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17735 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017736 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017737
17738 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17739 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17740 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17741 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17742 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017743 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017744
17745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177468.9. Examples of logs
17747---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017748
17749These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17750them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17751reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17752
17753 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17754 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17755 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17756
17757 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17758 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17759
17760 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17761 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17762 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17763
17764 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17765 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17766
17767 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17768 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17769 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17770
17771 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017772 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017773 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17774 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17775
17776 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17777 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17778 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17779
17780 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17781 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017782 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017783 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17784 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17785 to return the 502 and not the server.
17786
17787 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017788 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017789
17790 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17791 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17792 Nothing was sent to any server.
17793
17794 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17795 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17796
17797 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17798 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017799 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017800 send a 408 return code to the client.
17801
17802 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17803 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17804
17805 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17806 5 seconds ("c----").
17807
17808 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17809 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017810 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017811
17812 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017813 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017814 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17815 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17816 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17817 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17818 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017819
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017820
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178219. Supported filters
17822--------------------
17823
17824Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17825accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17826unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17827
17828See also : "filter"
17829
178309.1. Trace
17831----------
17832
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017833filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017834
17835 Arguments:
17836 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17837 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17838
17839 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17840 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17841 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17842 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17843
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017844 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017845 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17846 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17847 amount of the parsed data.
17848
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017849 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017850
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017851This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17852callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17853information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17854filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17855
17856Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17857tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17858a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17859
17860
178619.2. HTTP compression
17862---------------------
17863
17864filter compression
17865
17866The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17867keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017868when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17869it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17870response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17871line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17872cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17873the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017874
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017875See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017876
17877
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178789.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17879--------------------------------------------
17880
17881filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17882
17883 Arguments :
17884
17885 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17886 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17887 parsed.
17888
17889 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17890 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17891 part must be placed in its own scope.
17892
17893The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17894external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017895streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017896exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17897also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17898
17899SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17900the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17901
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017902For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017903"doc/SPOE.txt".
17904
17905Important note:
17906 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17907 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17908
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179099.4. Cache
17910----------
17911
17912filter cache <name>
17913
17914 Arguments :
17915
17916 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17917
17918The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17919"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17920cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017921other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17922the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17923mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17924filter other than the compression is used for the same
17925listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17926order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017927
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017928See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017929
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001793010. Cache
17931---------
17932
17933HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17934(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17935RAM.
17936
17937The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017938this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017939
17940If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17941independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17942when we try to allocate a new one.
17943
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017944The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017945
17946It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17947"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17948for more details.
17949
17950When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17951replaced by "<CACHE>".
17952
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001795310.1. Limitation
17954----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017955
17956The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17957
17958- If the response is not a 200
17959- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017960- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017961- If the response is not cacheable
17962
17963- If the request is not a GET
17964- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017965- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017966
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017967Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17968filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17969can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17970example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17971"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017972
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001797310.2. Setup
17974-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017975
17976To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17977the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17978
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001797910.2.1. Cache section
17980---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017981
17982cache <name>
17983 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17984 size of cache is mandatory.
17985
17986total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017987 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017988 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017989
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017990max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017991 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17992 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17993 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017994
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017995max-age <seconds>
17996 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17997 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17998 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17999 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18000 default.
18001
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001800210.2.2. Proxy section
18003---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018004
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018005http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018006 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18007 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18008 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18009 after this one.
18010
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018011http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018012 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18013 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18014 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18015 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18016
18017
18018Example:
18019
18020 backend bck1
18021 mode http
18022
18023 http-request cache-use foobar
18024 http-response cache-store foobar
18025 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18026
18027 cache foobar
18028 total-max-size 4
18029 max-age 240
18030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018031/*
18032 * Local variables:
18033 * fill-column: 79
18034 * End:
18035 */